* breakpoint.c (watchpoint_check): Expand the function description.
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
132 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
134 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
136 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
138 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
140 static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
142 static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
144 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
146 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
148 typedef enum
149 {
150 mark_inserted,
151 mark_uninserted
152 }
153 insertion_state_t;
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
162 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
164 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
166 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
170 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
176 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
178 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
182 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
184 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
190 static char *ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg);
191
192 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
193 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
194
195 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
196
197 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
198
199 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
200 CORE_ADDR pc);
201
202 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
203
204 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
205
206 static void update_global_location_list (int);
207
208 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
209
210 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
211
212 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
213
214 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
215
216 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
217
218 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
222 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
223
224 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
225
226 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
227
228
229 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
230 current breakpoint. */
231
232 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
233
234 static const char *
235 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
236 {
237 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
238 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
239 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
240 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
241 }
242
243 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
244 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
245 if such is available. */
246 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
247
248 static void
249 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
250 struct cmd_list_element *c,
251 const char *value)
252 {
253 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
254 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
255 value);
256 }
257
258 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
259 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
260 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
261 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
262 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
263 static void
264 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
265 struct cmd_list_element *c,
266 const char *value)
267 {
268 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
269 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
270 value);
271 }
272
273 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
274 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
275 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
276 use hardware breakpoints. */
277 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
278 static void
279 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
280 struct cmd_list_element *c,
281 const char *value)
282 {
283 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
284 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
285 value);
286 }
287
288 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
289 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
290 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
291 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
292 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
293
294 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
295 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
296 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
297 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
298 always_inserted_auto,
299 always_inserted_off,
300 always_inserted_on,
301 NULL
302 };
303 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
304 static void
305 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
306 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
307 {
308 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
309 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
310 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
311 value,
312 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
313 else
314 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
315 }
316
317 int
318 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
319 {
320 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
321 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
322 }
323
324 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
325
326 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
327 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
328
329 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
330 static int overlay_events_enabled;
331
332 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
334 breakpoint. */
335
336 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
337
338 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
339 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
340 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
341 B = TMP)
342
343 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
344 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
345 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
346
347 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
348 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
349 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
350 BP_TMP++)
351
352 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
353
354 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
355 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
356 if ((B)->type == bp_tracepoint)
357
358 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
359
360 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
361
362 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
363
364 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
365
366 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
367
368 static unsigned bp_location_count;
369
370 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
371 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
372 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
373 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
374
375 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
376
377 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
378 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
379 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
380 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
381 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
382
383 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
384
385 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
386 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
387 may still be reported by a target. */
388 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
389
390 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
391
392 int breakpoint_count;
393
394 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
395
396 int tracepoint_count;
397
398 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
399 static int
400 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
401 {
402 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
403 }
404
405 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
406
407 void
408 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
409 {
410 breakpoint_count = num;
411 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
412 }
413
414 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
415
416 void
417 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
418 {
419 struct breakpoint *b;
420
421 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
422 b->hit_count = 0;
423 }
424
425 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
426 for "break" command with no arg.
427 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
428 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
429
430 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
431
432 int default_breakpoint_valid;
433 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
434 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
435 int default_breakpoint_line;
436 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
437
438 \f
439 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
440 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
441
442 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
443 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
444 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
445
446 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
447
448 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
449 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
450 static int
451 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
452 {
453 int retval = 0; /* default */
454 char *p = *pp;
455
456 if (p == NULL)
457 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
458 return breakpoint_count;
459 else if (*p == '$')
460 {
461 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
462 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
463 char *varname;
464 char *start = ++p;
465 LONGEST val;
466
467 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
468 p++;
469 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
470 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
471 varname[p - start] = '\0';
472 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
473 retval = (int) val;
474 else
475 {
476 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
477 retval = 0;
478 }
479 }
480 else
481 {
482 if (*p == '-')
483 ++p;
484 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
485 ++p;
486 if (p == *pp)
487 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
488 {
489 /* Skip non-numeric token */
490 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
491 ++p;
492 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
493 retval = 0;
494 }
495 else
496 retval = atoi (*pp);
497 }
498 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
499 {
500 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
501 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
502 ++p;
503 retval = 0;
504 }
505 while (isspace (*p))
506 p++;
507 *pp = p;
508 return retval;
509 }
510
511
512 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
513 int
514 get_number (char **pp)
515 {
516 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
517 }
518
519 /* Parse a number or a range.
520 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
521 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
522 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
523 * inclusive.
524 *
525 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
526 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
527 *
528 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
529 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
530 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
531 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
532 * pointer PP past <number2>.
533 */
534
535 int
536 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
537 {
538 static int last_retval, end_value;
539 static char *end_ptr;
540 static int in_range = 0;
541
542 if (**pp != '-')
543 {
544 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
545 or to the first number of a range. */
546 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
547 if (**pp == '-')
548 {
549 char **temp;
550
551 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
552 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
553 and also remember the end of the final token. */
554
555 temp = &end_ptr;
556 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
557 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
558 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
559 end_value = get_number (temp);
560 if (end_value < last_retval)
561 {
562 error (_("inverted range"));
563 }
564 else if (end_value == last_retval)
565 {
566 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
567 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
568 single number. */
569 *pp = end_ptr;
570 }
571 else
572 in_range = 1;
573 }
574 }
575 else if (! in_range)
576 error (_("negative value"));
577 else
578 {
579 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
580 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
581 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
582 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
583 is reached. */
584
585 if (++last_retval == end_value)
586 {
587 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
588 *pp = end_ptr;
589 in_range = 0;
590 }
591 }
592 return last_retval;
593 }
594
595 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
596 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
597
598 struct breakpoint *
599 get_breakpoint (int num)
600 {
601 struct breakpoint *b;
602
603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
604 if (b->number == num)
605 return b;
606
607 return NULL;
608 }
609
610 \f
611 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
612
613 static void
614 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
615 {
616 struct breakpoint *b;
617 char *p;
618 int bnum;
619
620 if (arg == 0)
621 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
622
623 p = arg;
624 bnum = get_number (&p);
625 if (bnum == 0)
626 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
627
628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
629 if (b->number == bnum)
630 {
631 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
632 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
633 {
634 if (loc->cond)
635 {
636 xfree (loc->cond);
637 loc->cond = 0;
638 }
639 }
640 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
641 xfree (b->cond_string);
642
643 if (*p == 0)
644 {
645 b->cond_string = NULL;
646 if (from_tty)
647 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
648 }
649 else
650 {
651 arg = p;
652 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
653 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
654 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
655 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
656 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
657 {
658 arg = p;
659 loc->cond =
660 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
661 if (*arg)
662 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
663 }
664 }
665 breakpoints_changed ();
666 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
667 return;
668 }
669
670 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
671 }
672
673 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
674
675 void
676 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
677 {
678 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
679 b->commands = commands;
680 breakpoints_changed ();
681 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
682 }
683
684 static void
685 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
686 {
687 struct breakpoint *b;
688 char *p;
689 int bnum;
690 struct command_line *l;
691
692 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
693 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
694 being read from. */
695
696 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
697 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
698
699 p = arg;
700 bnum = get_number (&p);
701
702 if (p && *p)
703 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
704
705 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
706 if (b->number == bnum)
707 {
708 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
709 bnum);
710 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
711 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
712 do_cleanups (cleanups);
713 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
714 return;
715 }
716 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
717 }
718
719 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
720 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
721
722 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
723 that are part of if and while bodies. */
724 enum command_control_type
725 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
726 {
727 struct breakpoint *b;
728 char *p;
729 int bnum;
730
731 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
732 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
733 being read from. */
734
735 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
736 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
737
738 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
739 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
740 if (arg && !*arg)
741 p = NULL;
742 else
743 p = arg;
744 bnum = get_number (&p);
745
746 if (p && *p)
747 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
748
749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
750 if (b->number == bnum)
751 {
752 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
753 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
754 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
755 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
756 list after it finishes execution. */
757 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
758 breakpoints_changed ();
759 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
760 return simple_control;
761 }
762 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
763 }
764
765 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
766
767 static int
768 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
769 {
770 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
771 return 0;
772 if (!bl->inserted)
773 return 0;
774 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
775 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
776 return 0;
777 return 1;
778 }
779
780 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
781 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
782
783 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
784 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
785 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
786 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
787 memaddr ... memaddr + len
788 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
789 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
790 and:
791 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
792
793 void
794 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
795 {
796 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
797 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
798
799 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
800 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
801
802 bc_l = 0;
803 bc_r = bp_location_count;
804 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
805 {
806 struct bp_location *b;
807
808 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
809 b = bp_location[bc];
810
811 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
812 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
813 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
814
815 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
816 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
817 MEMADDR. */
818
819 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
820 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
821 bc_l = bc;
822 else
823 bc_r = bc;
824 }
825
826 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
827
828 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
829 {
830 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
831 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
832 int bp_size = 0;
833 int bptoffset = 0;
834
835 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
836 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
837 b->owner->number);
838
839 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
840 content. */
841
842 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
843 && memaddr + len <= b->address
844 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
845 break;
846
847 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
848 continue;
849 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
850 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
851 continue;
852
853 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
854 we need to copy. */
855 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
856 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
857
858 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
859 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
860 are reading. */
861 continue;
862
863 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
864 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
865 reading. */
866 continue;
867
868 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
869 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
870 {
871 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
872 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
873 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
874 bp_addr = memaddr;
875 }
876
877 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
878 {
879 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
880 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
881 }
882
883 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
884 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
885 }
886 }
887 \f
888
889 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
890 static void
891 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
892 {
893 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
894 int val = -1;
895
896 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
897 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
898
899 b->ops->insert (b);
900 }
901
902 static int
903 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
904 {
905 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
906 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
907 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
908 }
909
910 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
911 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
912 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
913 not need them.
914
915 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
916 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
917 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
918 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
919 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
920
921 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
922 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
923 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
924 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
925
926 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
927 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
928 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
929 chain. */
930
931 static void
932 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
933 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
934 {
935 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
936 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
937
938 *valp = NULL;
939 if (resultp)
940 *resultp = NULL;
941 if (val_chain)
942 *val_chain = NULL;
943
944 /* Evaluate the expression. */
945 mark = value_mark ();
946 result = NULL;
947
948 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
949 {
950 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
951 }
952 if (ex.reason < 0)
953 {
954 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
955 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
956 error to some higher catcher. */
957 switch (ex.error)
958 {
959 case MEMORY_ERROR:
960 break;
961 default:
962 throw_exception (ex);
963 break;
964 }
965 }
966
967 new_mark = value_mark ();
968 if (mark == new_mark)
969 return;
970 if (resultp)
971 *resultp = result;
972
973 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
974 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
975 if (result != NULL
976 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
977 *valp = result;
978
979 if (val_chain)
980 {
981 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
982 decide which addresses to watch. */
983 *val_chain = new_mark;
984 value_release_to_mark (mark);
985 }
986 }
987
988 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
989 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
990 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
991 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
992 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
993 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
994 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
995 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
996 running. */
997
998 static int
999 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1000 {
1001 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1002 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1003 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1004 }
1005
1006 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1007 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1008 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1009 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1010 in b->loc->cond.
1011 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1012
1013 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1014 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1015
1016 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1017 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1018 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1019 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1020 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1021 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1022 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1023
1024 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1025 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1026 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1027 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1028 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1029 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1030 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1031 memory content has not changed.
1032
1033 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1034 watchpoints:
1035
1036 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1037 several times when GDB stops.
1038
1039 [linux]
1040 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1041 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1042 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1043 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1044 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1045 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1046 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1047 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1048 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1049 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1050
1051 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1052 removal from inferior. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1056 {
1057 int within_current_scope;
1058 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1059 struct bp_location *loc;
1060 int frame_saved;
1061 bpstat bs;
1062
1063 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1064 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1065 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1066 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1067 return;
1068
1069 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1070 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1071 breakpoints if needed. */
1072 b->loc = NULL;
1073
1074 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1075 return;
1076
1077 frame_saved = 0;
1078
1079 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1080 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1081 within_current_scope = 1;
1082 else
1083 {
1084 struct frame_info *fi;
1085
1086 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1087 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1088 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1089 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1090 selected frame. */
1091 frame_saved = 1;
1092 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1093
1094 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1095 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1096 if (within_current_scope)
1097 select_frame (fi);
1098 }
1099
1100 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1101 {
1102 char *s;
1103 if (b->exp)
1104 {
1105 xfree (b->exp);
1106 b->exp = NULL;
1107 }
1108 s = b->exp_string;
1109 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1110 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1111 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1112 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1113 be completely different objects. */
1114 value_free (b->val);
1115 b->val = NULL;
1116 b->val_valid = 0;
1117 }
1118
1119 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1120 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1121 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1122 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1123 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1124 if ( !target_has_execution)
1125 {
1126 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1127 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1128 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1129 }
1130 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1131 {
1132 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1133 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1134
1135 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1136
1137 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1138 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1139 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1140 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1141 if (!b->val_valid)
1142 {
1143 b->val = v;
1144 b->val_valid = 1;
1145 }
1146
1147 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1148 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1149 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1150 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1151 && reparse)
1152 {
1153 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1154
1155 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1156 &other_type_used);
1157 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1158
1159 if (!mem_cnt)
1160 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1161 else
1162 {
1163 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1164 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1165 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1166 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1167 else
1168 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1169 }
1170 }
1171
1172 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1173
1174 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1175 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1176 {
1177 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1178 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1179 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1180 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1181 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1182 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1183 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1184 {
1185 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1186
1187 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1188 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1189 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1190 if (v == result
1191 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1192 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1193 {
1194 CORE_ADDR addr;
1195 int len, type;
1196 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1197
1198 addr = value_address (v);
1199 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1200 type = hw_write;
1201 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1202 type = hw_read;
1203 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1204 type = hw_access;
1205
1206 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1207 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1208 ;
1209 *tmp = loc;
1210 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1211
1212 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1213 loc->address = addr;
1214 loc->length = len;
1215 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1216 }
1217 }
1218
1219 next = value_next (v);
1220 if (v != b->val)
1221 value_free (v);
1222 }
1223
1224 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1225 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1226 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1227 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1228 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1229 {
1230 char *s = b->cond_string;
1231 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1232 }
1233 }
1234 else if (!within_current_scope)
1235 {
1236 printf_filtered (_("\
1237 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1238 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1239 b->number);
1240 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1241 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1242 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1246 if (frame_saved)
1247 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1248 }
1249
1250
1251 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1252 inserted in the inferior. */
1253 static int
1254 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1255 {
1256 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1257 return 0;
1258
1259 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1260 return 0;
1261
1262 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1263 return 0;
1264
1265 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1266 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1267 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1268 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1269 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1270 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1271 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1272 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1273 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1274 return 0;
1275
1276 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1277 not by us. */
1278 if (bpt->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
1279 return 0;
1280
1281 return 1;
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1285 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1286 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1287
1288 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1289 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1290 static int
1291 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1292 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1293 int *disabled_breaks,
1294 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1295 {
1296 int val = 0;
1297
1298 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1299 return 0;
1300
1301 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1302 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1303 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1304 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1305
1306 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1307 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1308 {
1309 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1310 {
1311 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1312 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1313 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1314 Two important cases are:
1315 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1316 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1317 hardware breakpoint.
1318 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1319 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1320 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1321
1322 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1323 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1324 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1325 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1326 struct mem_region *mr
1327 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1328
1329 if (mr)
1330 {
1331 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1332 {
1333 int changed = 0;
1334 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1335
1336 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1337 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1338 else
1339 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1340
1341 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1342 {
1343 static int said = 0;
1344 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1345 if (!said)
1346 {
1347 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1348 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1349 said = 1;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
1353 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1354 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1355 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1356 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1357 }
1358 }
1359
1360 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1361 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1362 || bpt->section == NULL
1363 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1364 {
1365 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1366
1367 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1368 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1369 &bpt->target_info);
1370 else
1371 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1372 &bpt->target_info);
1373 }
1374 else
1375 {
1376 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1377 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1378 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1379 {
1380 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1381 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1382 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1383 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1384 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1385 bpt->owner->number);
1386 else
1387 {
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1389 bpt->section);
1390 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1391 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1392 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1393 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1394 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1395 if (val != 0)
1396 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1397 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1398 bpt->owner->number);
1399 }
1400 }
1401 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1402 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1403 {
1404 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1405 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1406 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407 &bpt->target_info);
1408 else
1409 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1410 &bpt->target_info);
1411 }
1412 else
1413 {
1414 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1415 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1416 return 0;
1417 }
1418 }
1419
1420 if (val)
1421 {
1422 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1423 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1424 {
1425 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1426 val = 0;
1427 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1428 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1429 {
1430 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1431 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1432 bpt->owner->number);
1433 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1434 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1435 }
1436 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1437 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1438 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1439 }
1440 else
1441 {
1442 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1443 {
1444 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1445 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1446 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1447 bpt->owner->number);
1448 }
1449 else
1450 {
1451 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1452 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1453 bpt->owner->number);
1454 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1455 "Error accessing memory address ");
1456 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1457 tmp_error_stream);
1458 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1459 safe_strerror (val));
1460 }
1461
1462 }
1463 }
1464 else
1465 bpt->inserted = 1;
1466
1467 return val;
1468 }
1469
1470 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1471 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1472 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1473 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1474 {
1475 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1476 bpt->length,
1477 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1478 bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1479 }
1480
1481 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1482 {
1483 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1484 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1485 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1486 bpt->owner->number);
1487 if (e.reason < 0)
1488 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1489 else
1490 bpt->inserted = 1;
1491
1492 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1493 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1494 so just return success. */
1495 return 0;
1496 }
1497
1498 return 0;
1499 }
1500
1501 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1502 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1503 PSPACE anymore. */
1504
1505 void
1506 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1507 {
1508 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1509 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1510
1511 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1512 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1513 {
1514 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1515 delete_breakpoint (b);
1516 }
1517
1518 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1519 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1520 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1521 {
1522 struct bp_location *tmp;
1523
1524 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1525 {
1526 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1527 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1528 else
1529 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1530 if (tmp->next == loc)
1531 {
1532 tmp->next = loc->next;
1533 break;
1534 }
1535 }
1536 }
1537
1538 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1539 removed locations above. */
1540 update_global_location_list (0);
1541 }
1542
1543 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1544 Throws exception on any error.
1545 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1546 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1547 void
1548 insert_breakpoints (void)
1549 {
1550 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1551
1552 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1553 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1554 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1555
1556 update_global_location_list (1);
1557
1558 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1559 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1560 now. */
1561 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1562 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1563 }
1564
1565 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1566 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1567 Both return zero if successful,
1568 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1569
1570 static void
1571 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1572 {
1573 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1574 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1575 int error = 0;
1576 int val = 0;
1577 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1578 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1579
1580 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1581 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1582
1583 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1584 there was an error. */
1585 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1586
1587 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1588
1589 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1590 {
1591 struct thread_info *tp;
1592 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1593
1594 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1595 continue;
1596
1597 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1598 thread no longer exists. */
1599 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1600 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1601 continue;
1602
1603 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1604
1605 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1606 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1607 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1608 insert breakpoints. */
1609 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1610 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1611 continue;
1612
1613 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1614 &disabled_breaks,
1615 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1616 if (val)
1617 error = val;
1618 }
1619
1620 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1621 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1622 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1623 {
1624 int some_failed = 0;
1625 struct bp_location *loc;
1626
1627 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1628 continue;
1629
1630 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1631 continue;
1632
1633 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1634 continue;
1635
1636 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1637 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1638 {
1639 some_failed = 1;
1640 break;
1641 }
1642 if (some_failed)
1643 {
1644 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1645 if (loc->inserted)
1646 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1647
1648 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1649 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1650 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1651 bpt->number);
1652 error = -1;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 if (error)
1657 {
1658 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1659 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1660 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1661 {
1662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1664 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1665 }
1666 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1667 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1668 }
1669
1670 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1671 }
1672
1673 int
1674 remove_breakpoints (void)
1675 {
1676 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1677 int val = 0;
1678
1679 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1680 {
1681 if (b->inserted)
1682 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1683 }
1684 return val;
1685 }
1686
1687 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1688
1689 int
1690 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1691 {
1692 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1693 int val;
1694 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1695
1696 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1697 {
1698 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1699 continue;
1700
1701 if (b->inserted)
1702 {
1703 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1704 if (val != 0)
1705 return val;
1706 }
1707 }
1708 return 0;
1709 }
1710
1711 int
1712 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1713 {
1714 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1715 int val = 0;
1716
1717 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1718 {
1719 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1720 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1721 }
1722 return val;
1723 }
1724
1725 int
1726 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1727 {
1728 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1729 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1730 int val;
1731 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1732 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1733 struct inferior *inf;
1734 struct thread_info *tp;
1735
1736 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1737 if (tp == NULL)
1738 return 1;
1739
1740 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1741 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1742
1743 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1744
1745 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1746
1747 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1748 {
1749 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1750 continue;
1751
1752 if (b->inserted)
1753 {
1754 b->inserted = 0;
1755 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1756 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1757 if (val != 0)
1758 {
1759 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1760 return val;
1761 }
1762 }
1763 }
1764 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1765 return 0;
1766 }
1767
1768 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1769
1770 static struct breakpoint *
1771 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1772 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1773 {
1774 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1775 struct breakpoint *b;
1776
1777 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1778
1779 sal.pc = address;
1780 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1781 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1782
1783 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1784 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1785 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1786
1787 return b;
1788 }
1789
1790 static void
1791 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1792 {
1793 struct objfile *objfile;
1794
1795 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1796 {
1797 struct breakpoint *b;
1798 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1799
1800 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1801 if (m == NULL)
1802 continue;
1803
1804 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1805 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1806 bp_overlay_event);
1807 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1808
1809 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1810 {
1811 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1812 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1813 }
1814 else
1815 {
1816 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1817 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1818 }
1819 }
1820 update_global_location_list (1);
1821 }
1822
1823 static void
1824 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1825 {
1826 struct program_space *pspace;
1827 struct objfile *objfile;
1828 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1829
1830 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1831
1832 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1833 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1834 {
1835 struct breakpoint *b;
1836 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1837
1838 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1839 continue;
1840
1841 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1842
1843 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1844 if (m == NULL)
1845 continue;
1846
1847 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1848 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1849 bp_longjmp_master);
1850 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1851 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1852 }
1853 update_global_location_list (1);
1854
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 }
1857
1858 void
1859 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1860 {
1861 struct breakpoint *b;
1862 struct breakpoint *temp;
1863 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1864
1865 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1866 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1867 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1868 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1869 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1870 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1871 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1872 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1873 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1874 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1875 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1876
1877 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1878 {
1879 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1880 continue;
1881
1882 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1883 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1884 {
1885 delete_breakpoint (b);
1886 continue;
1887 }
1888
1889 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1890 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1891 {
1892 delete_breakpoint (b);
1893 continue;
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1897 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1898 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1899 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1900 {
1901 delete_breakpoint (b);
1902 continue;
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1906 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1907 {
1908 delete_breakpoint (b);
1909 continue;
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1913 after an exec. */
1914 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1915 {
1916 delete_breakpoint (b);
1917 continue;
1918 }
1919
1920 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1921 {
1922 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1923 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1924 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1925 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1926 continue;
1927 }
1928
1929 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1930 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1931 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1932 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1933 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1934 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1935
1936 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1937 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1938 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1939 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1940 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1941 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1942 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1943
1944 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1945 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1946 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1947 let finish_command delete it.
1948
1949 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1950 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1951 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1952 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1953 solib breakpoints.) */
1954
1955 if (b->type == bp_finish)
1956 {
1957 continue;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1961 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1962 a.out. */
1963 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1964 {
1965 delete_breakpoint (b);
1966 continue;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
1970 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1971 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1972 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1973 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1974 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1975 }
1976
1977 int
1978 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1979 {
1980 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1981 int val = 0;
1982 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1983 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1984
1985 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1986 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
1987
1988 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
1989 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
1990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1991 {
1992 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1993 continue;
1994
1995 if (b->inserted)
1996 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
1997 }
1998 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1999 return val;
2000 }
2001
2002 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2003 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2004 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2005 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2006 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2007
2008 static int
2009 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2010 {
2011 int val;
2012 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2013
2014 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2015 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2016 return 0;
2017
2018 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2019 This should not ever happen. */
2020 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2021
2022 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2023 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2024 {
2025 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2026 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2027 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2028
2029 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2030 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2031 || b->section == NULL
2032 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2033 {
2034 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2035
2036 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2038 else
2039 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2040 }
2041 else
2042 {
2043 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2044 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2045 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2046 {
2047 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2048 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2049 */
2050 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2051 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2052 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2053 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2054 &b->overlay_target_info);
2055 else
2056 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2057 &b->overlay_target_info);
2058 }
2059 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2060 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2061 if (b->inserted)
2062 {
2063 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2064 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2065 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2066 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2067 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2068 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2069 &b->target_info);
2070
2071 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2072 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2073 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2074 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2075 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2076 &b->target_info);
2077 else
2078 val = 0;
2079 }
2080 else
2081 {
2082 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2083 val = 0;
2084 }
2085 }
2086
2087 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2088 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2089 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2090 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2091 val = 0;
2092
2093 if (val)
2094 return val;
2095 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2096 }
2097 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2098 {
2099 struct value *v;
2100 struct value *n;
2101
2102 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2103 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2104 b->watchpoint_type);
2105
2106 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2107 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2108 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2109 b->owner->number);
2110 }
2111 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2112 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2113 && !b->duplicate)
2114 {
2115 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2116
2117 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2118 if (val)
2119 return val;
2120 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2121 }
2122
2123 return 0;
2124 }
2125
2126 static int
2127 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2128 {
2129 int ret;
2130 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2131
2132 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2133 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2134 return 0;
2135
2136 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2137 This should not ever happen. */
2138 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2139
2140 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2141
2142 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2143
2144 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2145
2146 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2147 return ret;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2151
2152 void
2153 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2154 {
2155 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2156
2157 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2158 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2159 bpt->inserted = 0;
2160 }
2161
2162 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2163 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2164
2165 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2166 between runs.
2167
2168 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2169 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2170 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2171
2172
2173
2174 void
2175 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2176 {
2177 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2178 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2179 int ix;
2180 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2181
2182 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2183 nothing to do. */
2184 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2185 return;
2186
2187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2188 {
2189 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2190 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2191 bpt->inserted = 0;
2192 }
2193
2194 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2195 {
2196 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2197 continue;
2198
2199 switch (b->type)
2200 {
2201 case bp_call_dummy:
2202 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2203
2204 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2205 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2206 get rid of it.
2207
2208 Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2209 delete_breakpoint (b);
2210 break;
2211
2212 case bp_watchpoint:
2213 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2214 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2215 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2216
2217 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2218 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2219 delete_breakpoint (b);
2220 else if (context == inf_starting)
2221 {
2222 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2223 in insert_breakpoints. */
2224 if (b->val)
2225 value_free (b->val);
2226 b->val = NULL;
2227 b->val_valid = 0;
2228 }
2229 break;
2230 default:
2231 break;
2232 }
2233 }
2234
2235 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2236 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2237 free_bp_location (bpt);
2238 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2239 }
2240
2241 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2242 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2243 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2244 match, not program space. */
2245
2246 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2247 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2248 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2249 permanent breakpoint.
2250 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2251 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2252 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2253 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2254 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2255
2256 enum breakpoint_here
2257 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2258 {
2259 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2260 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2261
2262 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2263 {
2264 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2265 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2266 continue;
2267
2268 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2269 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2270 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2271 aspace, pc))
2272 {
2273 if (overlay_debugging
2274 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2275 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2276 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2277 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2278 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2279 else
2280 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2281 }
2282 }
2283
2284 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2285 }
2286
2287 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2288
2289 int
2290 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2291 {
2292 struct bp_location *loc;
2293 int ix;
2294
2295 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2296 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2297 aspace, pc))
2298 return 1;
2299
2300 return 0;
2301 }
2302
2303 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2304 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2305 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2306 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2307
2308 int
2309 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2310 {
2311 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2312
2313 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2314 {
2315 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2316 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2317 continue;
2318
2319 if (bpt->inserted
2320 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2321 aspace, pc))
2322 {
2323 if (overlay_debugging
2324 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2325 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2326 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2327 else
2328 return 1;
2329 }
2330 }
2331 return 0;
2332 }
2333
2334 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2335 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2336
2337 int
2338 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2339 {
2340 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2341 return 1;
2342
2343 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2344 return 1;
2345
2346 return 0;
2347 }
2348
2349 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2350 inserted at PC. */
2351
2352 int
2353 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2354 {
2355 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2356 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2357
2358 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2359 {
2360 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2361 continue;
2362
2363 if (bpt->inserted
2364 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2365 aspace, pc))
2366 {
2367 if (overlay_debugging
2368 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2369 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2370 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2371 else
2372 return 1;
2373 }
2374 }
2375
2376 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2377 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2378 return 1;
2379
2380 return 0;
2381 }
2382
2383 int
2384 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2385 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2386 {
2387 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2388
2389 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2390 {
2391 struct bp_location *loc;
2392
2393 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2394 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2395 continue;
2396
2397 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2398 continue;
2399
2400 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2401 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2402 {
2403 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2404
2405 /* Check for intersection. */
2406 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2407 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2408 if (l < h)
2409 return 1;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 return 0;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2416 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2417
2418 int
2419 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2420 ptid_t ptid)
2421 {
2422 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2423 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2424 int thread = -1;
2425 int task = 0;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2434 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2435 continue;
2436
2437 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2438 aspace, pc))
2439 continue;
2440
2441 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2442 {
2443 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2444 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2445 it is now time to do so. */
2446 if (thread == -1)
2447 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2448 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2449 continue;
2450 }
2451
2452 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2453 {
2454 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2455 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2456 it is now time to do so. */
2457 if (task == 0)
2458 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2459 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2460 continue;
2461 }
2462
2463 if (overlay_debugging
2464 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2465 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2466 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2467
2468 return 1;
2469 }
2470
2471 return 0;
2472 }
2473 \f
2474
2475 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2476 in breakpoint.h. */
2477
2478 int
2479 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2480 {
2481 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2482 }
2483
2484 void
2485 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2486 {
2487 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2488 value_free (bs->old_val);
2489 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2490 xfree (bs);
2491 }
2492
2493 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2494 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2495
2496 void
2497 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2498 {
2499 bpstat p;
2500 bpstat q;
2501
2502 if (bsp == 0)
2503 return;
2504 p = *bsp;
2505 while (p != NULL)
2506 {
2507 q = p->next;
2508 bpstat_free (p);
2509 p = q;
2510 }
2511 *bsp = NULL;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2515 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2516
2517 bpstat
2518 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2519 {
2520 bpstat p = NULL;
2521 bpstat tmp;
2522 bpstat retval = NULL;
2523
2524 if (bs == NULL)
2525 return bs;
2526
2527 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2528 {
2529 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2530 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2531 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2532 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2533 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2534 {
2535 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2536 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2537 }
2538
2539 if (p == NULL)
2540 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2541 retval = tmp;
2542 else
2543 p->next = tmp;
2544 p = tmp;
2545 }
2546 p->next = NULL;
2547 return retval;
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2551
2552 bpstat
2553 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2554 {
2555 if (bsp == NULL)
2556 return NULL;
2557
2558 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2559 {
2560 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2561 return bsp;
2562 }
2563 return NULL;
2564 }
2565
2566 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2567 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2568 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2569
2570 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2571 step_resume breakpoint.
2572
2573 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2574 struct breakpoint *
2575 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2576 {
2577 int current_thread;
2578
2579 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2580
2581 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2582
2583 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2584 {
2585 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2586 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2587 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2588 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2589 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2590 }
2591
2592 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2597 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2598 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2599 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2600 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2601 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2602 we set it.
2603 Return 1 otherwise. */
2604
2605 int
2606 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2607 {
2608 struct breakpoint *b;
2609
2610 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2611 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2612
2613 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2614 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2615 this function might return the same number more
2616 than once and this will look ugly. */
2617 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2618 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2619 if (b == NULL)
2620 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2621
2622 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2623 return 1;
2624 }
2625
2626 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2627
2628 void
2629 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2630 {
2631 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2632 {
2633 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2634 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2635 {
2636 value_free (bs->old_val);
2637 bs->old_val = NULL;
2638 }
2639 }
2640 }
2641
2642 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2643
2644 static void
2645 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2646 {
2647 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2648 {
2649 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2650
2651 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2652 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2653 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2654 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2655 if (tp->in_infcall)
2656 return;
2657 }
2658
2659 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2660 }
2661
2662 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2663 static void
2664 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2665 {
2666 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2670 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2671 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2672 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2673
2674 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2675 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2676 bpstat of the current thread. */
2677
2678 static int
2679 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2680 {
2681 bpstat bs;
2682 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2683 int again = 0;
2684
2685 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2686 in bs->commands. */
2687 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2688 return 0;
2689
2690 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2691 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2692
2693 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2694 bs = *bsp;
2695
2696 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2697 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2698 {
2699 struct command_line *cmd;
2700 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2701
2702 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2703
2704 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2705 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2706 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2707 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2708 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2709 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2710 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2711 the tree when we're done. */
2712 cmd = bs->commands;
2713 bs->commands = 0;
2714 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2715
2716 while (cmd != NULL)
2717 {
2718 execute_control_command (cmd);
2719
2720 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2721 break;
2722 else
2723 cmd = cmd->next;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2727 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2728
2729 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2730 {
2731 if (target_can_async_p ())
2732 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2733 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2734 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2735 ;
2736 else
2737 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2738 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2739 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2740 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2741 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2742 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2743 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2744 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2745 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2746 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2747 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2748 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2749 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2750 again = 1;
2751 break;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2755 return again;
2756 }
2757
2758 void
2759 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2760 {
2761 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2762 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2763 && target_has_execution
2764 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2765 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2766 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2767 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2768 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2769 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2770 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2771 break;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2775
2776 static void
2777 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2778 {
2779 if (val == NULL)
2780 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2781 else
2782 {
2783 struct value_print_options opts;
2784 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2785 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2790 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2791 by having it set different print_it values.
2792
2793 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2794 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2795 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2796 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2797 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2798
2799 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2800 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2801 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2802 don't print anything else.
2803 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2804 that something to be followed by a location.
2805 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2806 that something to be followed by a location.
2807 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2808 analysis. */
2809
2810 static enum print_stop_action
2811 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2812 {
2813 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2814 struct breakpoint *b;
2815 const struct bp_location *bl;
2816 struct ui_stream *stb;
2817 int bp_temp = 0;
2818 enum print_stop_action result;
2819
2820 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2821 which has since been deleted. */
2822 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2823 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2824 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2825 b = bl->owner;
2826
2827 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2828 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2829
2830 switch (b->type)
2831 {
2832 case bp_breakpoint:
2833 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2834 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2835 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2836 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2837 bl->address,
2838 b->number, 1);
2839 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2840 if (bp_temp)
2841 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2842 else
2843 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2844 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2845 {
2846 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2847 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2848 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2849 }
2850 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2851 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2852 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2853 break;
2854
2855 case bp_shlib_event:
2856 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2857 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2858 to shlib event" message.) */
2859 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2860 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2861 break;
2862
2863 case bp_thread_event:
2864 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2865 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2866 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2867 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2868 break;
2869
2870 case bp_overlay_event:
2871 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2872 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2873 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874 break;
2875
2876 case bp_longjmp_master:
2877 /* These should never be enabled. */
2878 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2879 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2880 break;
2881
2882 case bp_watchpoint:
2883 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2884 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2885 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2886 ui_out_field_string
2887 (uiout, "reason",
2888 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2889 mention (b);
2890 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2891 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2892 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2893 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2894 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2895 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2896 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2897 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2898 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2899 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2900 break;
2901
2902 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2903 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2904 ui_out_field_string
2905 (uiout, "reason",
2906 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2907 mention (b);
2908 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2909 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2910 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2911 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2912 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2913 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2914 break;
2915
2916 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2917 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2918 {
2919 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2920 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2921 ui_out_field_string
2922 (uiout, "reason",
2923 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2924 mention (b);
2925 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2926 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2927 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2928 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2929 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2930 }
2931 else
2932 {
2933 mention (b);
2934 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2935 ui_out_field_string
2936 (uiout, "reason",
2937 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2938 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2940 }
2941 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2942 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2943 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2944 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2945 break;
2946
2947 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2948 here. */
2949
2950 case bp_finish:
2951 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2952 ui_out_field_string
2953 (uiout, "reason",
2954 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2955 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2956 break;
2957
2958 case bp_until:
2959 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2960 ui_out_field_string
2961 (uiout, "reason",
2962 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2963 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2964 break;
2965
2966 case bp_none:
2967 case bp_longjmp:
2968 case bp_longjmp_resume:
2969 case bp_step_resume:
2970 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2971 case bp_call_dummy:
2972 case bp_tracepoint:
2973 case bp_jit_event:
2974 default:
2975 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2976 break;
2977 }
2978
2979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2980 return result;
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2984 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2985 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
2986 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
2987 normal_stop(). */
2988
2989 static enum print_stop_action
2990 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
2991 {
2992 switch (bs->print_it)
2993 {
2994 case print_it_noop:
2995 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
2996 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2997 break;
2998
2999 case print_it_done:
3000 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3001 relevant messages. */
3002 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3003 break;
3004
3005 case print_it_normal:
3006 {
3007 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3008 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3009
3010 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3011 print_it_typical. */
3012 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3013 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3014 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3015 else
3016 return print_it_typical (bs);
3017 }
3018 break;
3019
3020 default:
3021 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3022 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3023 break;
3024 }
3025 }
3026
3027 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3028 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3029 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3030 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3031 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3032 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3033 routine is one of:
3034
3035 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3036 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3037 code to print the location. An example is
3038 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3039 the location.
3040 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3041 to also print the location part of the message.
3042 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3043 don't require a location appended to the end.
3044 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3045 further info to be printed.*/
3046
3047 enum print_stop_action
3048 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3049 {
3050 int val;
3051
3052 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3053 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3054 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3055 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3056 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3057 {
3058 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3059 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3060 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3061 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3062 return val;
3063 }
3064
3065 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3066 with and nothing was printed. */
3067 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3068 }
3069
3070 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3071 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3072 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3073 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3074
3075 static int
3076 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3077 {
3078 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3079 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3080 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3081 return i;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3085
3086 static bpstat
3087 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3088 {
3089 bpstat bs;
3090
3091 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3092 cbs->next = bs;
3093 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3094 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3095 bs->commands = NULL;
3096 bs->old_val = NULL;
3097 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3098 return bs;
3099 }
3100 \f
3101 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3102 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3103
3104 int
3105 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3106 {
3107 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3108 CORE_ADDR addr;
3109 struct breakpoint *b;
3110
3111 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3112 {
3113 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3114 as not triggered. */
3115 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3116 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3117 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3118 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3119 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3120
3121 return 0;
3122 }
3123
3124 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3125 {
3126 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3127 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3130 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3131 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3132 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3133
3134 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3138 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3139 triggered. */
3140
3141 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3142 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3143 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3144 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3145 {
3146 struct bp_location *loc;
3147 struct value *v;
3148
3149 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3150 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3151 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3152 sufficient. */
3153 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3154 addr, loc->address,
3155 loc->length))
3156 {
3157 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3158 break;
3159 }
3160 }
3161
3162 return 1;
3163 }
3164
3165 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3166 because of check_errors). */
3167 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3168 #define WP_DELETED 1
3169 /* The value has changed. */
3170 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3171 /* The value has not changed. */
3172 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3173
3174 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3175 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3176
3177 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3178
3179 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3180 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3181
3182 static int
3183 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3184 {
3185 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3186 struct breakpoint *b;
3187 struct frame_info *fr;
3188 int within_current_scope;
3189
3190 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3191
3192 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3193 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3194 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3195 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3196 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3197
3198 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3199 within_current_scope = 1;
3200 else
3201 {
3202 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3203 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3204 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3205
3206 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3207 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3208
3209 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3210 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3211 if (within_current_scope)
3212 {
3213 struct symbol *function;
3214
3215 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3216 if (function == NULL
3217 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3218 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3219 within_current_scope = 0;
3220 }
3221
3222 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3223 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3224 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3225 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3226 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3227 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3228 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3229 is likely to be wrong. */
3230 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3231 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3232
3233 if (within_current_scope)
3234 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3235 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3236 the user. */
3237 select_frame (fr);
3238 }
3239
3240 if (within_current_scope)
3241 {
3242 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3243 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3244 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3245 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3246
3247 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3248 struct value *new_val;
3249
3250 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3251
3252 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3253 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3254 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3255 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3256 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3257 {
3258 if (new_val != NULL)
3259 {
3260 release_value (new_val);
3261 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3262 }
3263 bs->old_val = b->val;
3264 b->val = new_val;
3265 b->val_valid = 1;
3266 /* We will stop here */
3267 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3268 }
3269 else
3270 {
3271 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3272 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3273 /* We won't stop here */
3274 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3275 }
3276 }
3277 else
3278 {
3279 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3280 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3281 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3282 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3283 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3284 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3285 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3286 the first value assigned). */
3287 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3288 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3289 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3290 information here. */
3291 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3292 ui_out_field_string
3293 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3294 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3295 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3296 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3297 which its expression is valid.\n");
3298
3299 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3300 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3301 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3302
3303 return WP_DELETED;
3304 }
3305 }
3306
3307 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3308 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3309 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3310 static int
3311 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3312 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3313 {
3314 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3315
3316 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3317 tracepoints. */
3318 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
3319 return 0;
3320
3321 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3322 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3323 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3324 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3325 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3326 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3327 {
3328 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3329 aspace, bp_addr))
3330 return 0;
3331 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3332 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3333 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3334 return 0;
3335 }
3336
3337 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3338 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3339 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3340 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3341 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3342 (did not match the data address). */
3343
3344 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3345 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3346 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3347 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3348 return 0;
3349
3350 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3351 {
3352 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3353 return 0;
3354 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3355 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3356 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3357 return 0;
3358 }
3359
3360 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3361 {
3362 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3363 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3364 return 0;
3365 }
3366
3367 return 1;
3368 }
3369
3370 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3371 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3372 to 0. */
3373 static void
3374 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3375 {
3376 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3377 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3378
3379 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3380 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3381 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3382 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3383 {
3384 CORE_ADDR addr;
3385 struct value *v;
3386 int must_check_value = 0;
3387
3388 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3389 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3390 watched value. */
3391 must_check_value = 1;
3392 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3393 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3394 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3395 this watchpoint. */
3396 must_check_value = 1;
3397 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3398 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3399 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3400 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3401 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3402 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3403 must_check_value = 1;
3404
3405 if (must_check_value)
3406 {
3407 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3408 b->number);
3409 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3410 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3411 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3412 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3413 switch (e)
3414 {
3415 case WP_DELETED:
3416 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3417 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3418 /* Stop. */
3419 break;
3420 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3421 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3422 {
3423 /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3424 the value has changed. This is for targets
3425 which cannot set read-only watchpoints. */
3426 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3427 bs->stop = 0;
3428 }
3429 break;
3430 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3431 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3432 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3433 {
3434 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3435 the value hasn't changed. */
3436 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3437 bs->stop = 0;
3438 }
3439 /* Stop. */
3440 break;
3441 default:
3442 /* Can't happen. */
3443 case 0:
3444 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3445 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3446 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3447 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3448 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3449 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3450 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3451 break;
3452 }
3453 }
3454 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3455 {
3456 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3457 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3458 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3459 anything for this watchpoint. */
3460 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3461 bs->stop = 0;
3462 }
3463 }
3464 }
3465
3466
3467 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3468 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3469 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3470 static void
3471 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3472 {
3473 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3474 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3475 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3476
3477 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3478 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3479 bs->stop = 0;
3480 else if (bs->stop)
3481 {
3482 int value_is_zero = 0;
3483
3484 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3485 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3486 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3487 iteration. */
3488 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3489 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3490
3491 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3492 {
3493 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3494 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3495 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3496 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3497 function call. */
3498 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3499
3500 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3501 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3502 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3503 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3504 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3505 call site. */
3506 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3507 value_is_zero
3508 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3509 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3510 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3511 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3512 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3513 }
3514 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3515 {
3516 bs->stop = 0;
3517 }
3518 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3519 {
3520 bs->stop = 0;
3521 }
3522 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3523 {
3524 b->ignore_count--;
3525 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3526 bs->stop = 0;
3527 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3528 stop. */
3529 ++(b->hit_count);
3530 }
3531 }
3532 }
3533
3534
3535 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3536 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3537
3538 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3539 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3540
3541 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3542
3543 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3544
3545 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3546 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3547 several reasons concurrently.)
3548
3549 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3550 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3551
3552 bpstat
3553 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3554 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3555 {
3556 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3557 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3558 struct bp_location *loc;
3559 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3560 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3561 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3562 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3563 int ix;
3564 int need_remove_insert;
3565
3566 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3567 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3568 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3569
3570 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3571 {
3572 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3573 continue;
3574
3575 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3576 {
3577 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3578 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3579 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3580 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3581 already. */
3582 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3583 break;
3584
3585 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3586 continue;
3587
3588 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3589 continue;
3590
3591 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3592
3593 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3594
3595 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3596 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3597 'stop' to 0. */
3598 bs->stop = 1;
3599 bs->print = 1;
3600
3601 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3602 if (!bs->stop)
3603 continue;
3604
3605 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3606 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3607 /* We do not stop for these. */
3608 bs->stop = 0;
3609 else
3610 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3611
3612 if (bs->stop)
3613 {
3614 ++(b->hit_count);
3615
3616 /* We will stop here */
3617 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3618 {
3619 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3620 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3621 update_global_location_list (0);
3622 }
3623 if (b->silent)
3624 bs->print = 0;
3625 bs->commands = b->commands;
3626 if (bs->commands
3627 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3628 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3629 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3630 {
3631 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3632 bs->print = 0;
3633 }
3634 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3635 }
3636
3637 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3638 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3639 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3640 }
3641 }
3642
3643 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3644 {
3645 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3646 aspace, bp_addr))
3647 {
3648 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3649 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3650 bs->stop = 0;
3651 bs->print = 0;
3652 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3653 }
3654 }
3655
3656 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3657 bs = root_bs->next; /* Re-grab the head of the chain */
3658
3659 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3660 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3661 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3662 done later. */
3663 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3664 if (bs->stop)
3665 break;
3666
3667 need_remove_insert = 0;
3668 if (bs == NULL)
3669 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3670 if (!bs->stop
3671 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3672 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3673 {
3674 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3675 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3676 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3677 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3678 need_remove_insert = 1;
3679 }
3680
3681 if (need_remove_insert)
3682 update_global_location_list (1);
3683
3684 return root_bs->next;
3685 }
3686 \f
3687 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3688 struct bpstat_what
3689 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3690 {
3691 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3692 enum class
3693 {
3694 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3695 no_effect = 0,
3696
3697 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3698 wp_silent,
3699
3700 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3701 wp_noisy,
3702
3703 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3704 bp_nostop,
3705
3706 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3707 bp_silent,
3708
3709 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3710 bp_noisy,
3711
3712 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3713 long_jump,
3714
3715 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3716 long_resume,
3717
3718 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3719 step_resume,
3720
3721 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3722 shlib_event,
3723
3724 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3725 jit_event,
3726
3727 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3728 class_last
3729 };
3730
3731 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3732 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3733 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3734 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3735 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3736 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3737 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3738 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3739 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3740 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3741 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3742 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3743
3744 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3745 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3746 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3747 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3748
3749 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3750 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3751 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3752 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3753 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3754 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3755 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3756
3757 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3758 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3759 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3760 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3761 ordering is:
3762
3763 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3764 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3765 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3766 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3767 ss < jit shl sn sr
3768 sn < jit shl sr
3769 jit < shl sr
3770 shl < sr
3771 sr <
3772
3773 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3774 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3775 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3776 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3777 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3778
3779 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3780 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3781 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3782
3783 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3784 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3785 {
3786 /* old action */
3787 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3788 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3789 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3790 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3791 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3792 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3793 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3794 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3795 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3796 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3797 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3798 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3799 };
3800
3801 #undef kc
3802 #undef ss
3803 #undef sn
3804 #undef sgl
3805 #undef slr
3806 #undef clr
3807 #undef err
3808 #undef sr
3809 #undef ts
3810 #undef shl
3811 #undef jit
3812 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3813 struct bpstat_what retval;
3814
3815 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3816 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3817 {
3818 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3819 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3820 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3821 which has since been deleted. */
3822 continue;
3823 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3824 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3825 else
3826 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3827 {
3828 case bp_none:
3829 continue;
3830
3831 case bp_breakpoint:
3832 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3833 case bp_until:
3834 case bp_finish:
3835 if (bs->stop)
3836 {
3837 if (bs->print)
3838 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3839 else
3840 bs_class = bp_silent;
3841 }
3842 else
3843 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3844 break;
3845 case bp_watchpoint:
3846 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3847 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3848 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3849 if (bs->stop)
3850 {
3851 if (bs->print)
3852 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3853 else
3854 bs_class = wp_silent;
3855 }
3856 else
3857 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3858 This requires no further action. */
3859 bs_class = no_effect;
3860 break;
3861 case bp_longjmp:
3862 bs_class = long_jump;
3863 break;
3864 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3865 bs_class = long_resume;
3866 break;
3867 case bp_step_resume:
3868 if (bs->stop)
3869 {
3870 bs_class = step_resume;
3871 }
3872 else
3873 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3874 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3875 break;
3876 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3877 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3878 break;
3879 case bp_shlib_event:
3880 bs_class = shlib_event;
3881 break;
3882 case bp_jit_event:
3883 bs_class = jit_event;
3884 break;
3885 case bp_thread_event:
3886 case bp_overlay_event:
3887 case bp_longjmp_master:
3888 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3889 break;
3890 case bp_catchpoint:
3891 if (bs->stop)
3892 {
3893 if (bs->print)
3894 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3895 else
3896 bs_class = bp_silent;
3897 }
3898 else
3899 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3900 This requires no further action. */
3901 bs_class = no_effect;
3902 break;
3903 case bp_call_dummy:
3904 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3905 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
3906 bs_class = bp_silent;
3907 retval.call_dummy = 1;
3908 break;
3909 case bp_tracepoint:
3910 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3911 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3912 out already. */
3913 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3914 _("bpstat_what: bp_tracepoint encountered"));
3915 break;
3916 }
3917 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3918 }
3919 retval.main_action = current_action;
3920 return retval;
3921 }
3922
3923 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3924 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3925 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
3926
3927 int
3928 bpstat_should_step (void)
3929 {
3930 struct breakpoint *b;
3931 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3932 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3933 return 1;
3934 return 0;
3935 }
3936
3937 int
3938 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3939 {
3940 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3941 if (bs->stop)
3942 return 1;
3943
3944 return 0;
3945 }
3946
3947 \f
3948
3949 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
3950
3951 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3952 struct bp_location *loc,
3953 char *wrap_indent,
3954 struct ui_stream *stb)
3955 {
3956 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3957
3958 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
3959 loc = NULL;
3960
3961 if (loc != NULL)
3962 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3963
3964 if (b->source_file && loc)
3965 {
3966 struct symbol *sym
3967 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3968 if (sym)
3969 {
3970 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3971 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3972 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3973 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3974 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3975 }
3976 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3977 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3978
3979 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3980 {
3981 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3982 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3983
3984 if (fullname)
3985 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
3986 }
3987
3988 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
3989 }
3990 else if (loc)
3991 {
3992 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
3993 demangle, "");
3994 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
3995 }
3996 else
3997 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
3998
3999 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4000 }
4001
4002 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4003 static void
4004 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4005 struct bp_location *loc,
4006 int loc_number,
4007 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4008 int print_address_bits,
4009 int allflag)
4010 {
4011 struct command_line *l;
4012 struct symbol *sym;
4013 struct ep_type_description
4014 {
4015 enum bptype type;
4016 char *description;
4017 };
4018 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4019 {
4020 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4021 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4022 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4023 {bp_until, "until"},
4024 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4025 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4026 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4027 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4028 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4029 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4030 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4031 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4032 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4033 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4034 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4035 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4036 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4037 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4038 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4039 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4040 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4041 };
4042
4043 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4044 char wrap_indent[80];
4045 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4046 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4047 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4048
4049 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4050 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4051 struct value_print_options opts;
4052
4053 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4054
4055 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4056 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4057 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4058 location. */
4059 if (loc == NULL
4060 && (b->loc != NULL
4061 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4062 header_of_multiple = 1;
4063 if (loc == NULL)
4064 loc = b->loc;
4065
4066 annotate_record ();
4067 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4068
4069 /* 1 */
4070 annotate_field (0);
4071 if (part_of_multiple)
4072 {
4073 char *formatted;
4074 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4075 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4076 xfree (formatted);
4077 }
4078 else
4079 {
4080 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4081 }
4082
4083 /* 2 */
4084 annotate_field (1);
4085 if (part_of_multiple)
4086 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4087 else
4088 {
4089 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4090 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4091 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4092 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4093 (int) b->type);
4094 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4095 }
4096
4097 /* 3 */
4098 annotate_field (2);
4099 if (part_of_multiple)
4100 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4101 else
4102 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4103
4104
4105 /* 4 */
4106 annotate_field (3);
4107 if (part_of_multiple)
4108 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4109 else
4110 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4111 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4112 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4113
4114
4115 /* 5 and 6 */
4116 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4117 if (opts.addressprint)
4118 {
4119 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4120 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4121 else
4122 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4123 }
4124
4125 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4126 {
4127 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4128 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4129 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4130 just one location. */
4131 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4132 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4133 }
4134 else
4135 switch (b->type)
4136 {
4137 case bp_none:
4138 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4139 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4140 break;
4141
4142 case bp_watchpoint:
4143 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4144 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4145 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4146 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4147 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4148 is relatively readable). */
4149 if (opts.addressprint)
4150 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4151 annotate_field (5);
4152 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4153 break;
4154
4155 case bp_breakpoint:
4156 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4157 case bp_until:
4158 case bp_finish:
4159 case bp_longjmp:
4160 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4161 case bp_step_resume:
4162 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4163 case bp_call_dummy:
4164 case bp_shlib_event:
4165 case bp_thread_event:
4166 case bp_overlay_event:
4167 case bp_longjmp_master:
4168 case bp_tracepoint:
4169 case bp_jit_event:
4170 if (opts.addressprint)
4171 {
4172 annotate_field (4);
4173 if (header_of_multiple)
4174 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4175 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4176 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4177 else
4178 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4179 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4180 }
4181 annotate_field (5);
4182 if (!header_of_multiple)
4183 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4184 if (b->loc)
4185 *last_loc = b->loc;
4186 break;
4187 }
4188
4189
4190 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4191 are several. */
4192 if (loc != NULL
4193 && !header_of_multiple
4194 && (allflag
4195 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4196 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4197 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4198 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4199 {
4200 struct inferior *inf;
4201 int first = 1;
4202
4203 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4204 {
4205 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4206 {
4207 if (first)
4208 {
4209 first = 0;
4210 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4211 }
4212 else
4213 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4214 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4215 }
4216 }
4217 }
4218
4219 if (!part_of_multiple)
4220 {
4221 if (b->thread != -1)
4222 {
4223 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4224 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4225 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4226 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4227 }
4228 else if (b->task != 0)
4229 {
4230 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4231 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4232 }
4233 }
4234
4235 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4236
4237 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4238 {
4239 annotate_field (6);
4240 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4241 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4242 the frame ID. */
4243 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4244 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4245 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4246 }
4247
4248 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4249 {
4250 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4251 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4252 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4253 annotate_field (7);
4254 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
4255 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4256 else
4257 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4258 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4259 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4260 }
4261
4262 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4263 {
4264 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4265 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4266 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4267 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4268 }
4269
4270 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4271 {
4272 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4273 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4274 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4275 else
4276 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4277 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4278 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4279 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4280 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4281 else
4282 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4283 }
4284
4285 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4286 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4287 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4288 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4289 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4290
4291 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4292 {
4293 annotate_field (8);
4294 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4295 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4296 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4297 }
4298
4299 l = b->commands;
4300 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4301 {
4302 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4303
4304 annotate_field (9);
4305 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4306 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4307 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4308 }
4309
4310 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4311 {
4312 annotate_field (10);
4313 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4314 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4315 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4316 }
4317
4318 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4319 {
4320 annotate_field (11);
4321 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4322 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4323 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4324 }
4325
4326 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4327 {
4328 struct action_line *action;
4329 annotate_field (12);
4330 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4331 {
4332 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4333 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4334 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4335 }
4336 }
4337
4338 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4339 {
4340 if (b->addr_string)
4341 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4342 else if (b->exp_string)
4343 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4344 }
4345
4346 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4347 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4348 }
4349
4350 static void
4351 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4352 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4353 int allflag)
4354 {
4355 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4356 print_address_bits, allflag);
4357
4358 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4359 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4360 locations, if any. */
4361 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4362 {
4363 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4364 disabled, we print it as if it had
4365 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4366 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4367 situation.
4368 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4369 several locations internally, that's no a property
4370 exposed to user. */
4371 if (b->loc
4372 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4373 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4374 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4375 {
4376 struct bp_location *loc;
4377 int n = 1;
4378 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4379 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4380 print_address_bits, allflag);
4381 }
4382 }
4383 }
4384
4385 static int
4386 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4387 {
4388 int print_address_bits = 0;
4389 struct bp_location *loc;
4390
4391 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4392 {
4393 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4394 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4395 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4396 }
4397
4398 return print_address_bits;
4399 }
4400
4401 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4402 {
4403 int bnum;
4404 };
4405
4406 static int
4407 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4408 {
4409 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4410 struct breakpoint *b;
4411 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4412 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4413 {
4414 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4415 {
4416 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4417 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4418 return GDB_RC_OK;
4419 }
4420 }
4421 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4422 }
4423
4424 enum gdb_rc
4425 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4426 {
4427 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4428 args.bnum = bnum;
4429 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4430 an error. */
4431 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4432 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4433 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4434 else
4435 return GDB_RC_OK;
4436 }
4437
4438 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4439 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4440
4441 static int
4442 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4443 {
4444 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4445 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4446 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4447 || b->type == bp_tracepoint
4448 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4449 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4450 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4451 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4452 }
4453
4454 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4455 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4456 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4457
4458 static void
4459 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4460 {
4461 struct breakpoint *b;
4462 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4463 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4464 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4465 struct value_print_options opts;
4466 int print_address_bits = 0;
4467
4468 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4469
4470 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4471 size required for address fields. */
4472 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4473 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4474 if (bnum == -1
4475 || bnum == b->number)
4476 {
4477 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4478 {
4479 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4480 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4481 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4482
4483 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4484 }
4485 }
4486
4487 if (opts.addressprint)
4488 bkpttbl_chain
4489 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4490 "BreakpointTable");
4491 else
4492 bkpttbl_chain
4493 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4494 "BreakpointTable");
4495
4496 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4497 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4498 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4499 annotate_field (0);
4500 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4501 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4502 annotate_field (1);
4503 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4504 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4505 annotate_field (2);
4506 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4507 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4508 annotate_field (3);
4509 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4510 if (opts.addressprint)
4511 {
4512 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4513 annotate_field (4);
4514 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4515 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4516 else
4517 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4518 }
4519 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4520 annotate_field (5);
4521 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4522 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4524 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4525
4526 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4527 if (bnum == -1
4528 || bnum == b->number)
4529 {
4530 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4531 allflag is set. */
4532 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4533 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4534 }
4535
4536 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4537
4538 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4539 {
4540 if (bnum == -1)
4541 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4542 else
4543 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4544 bnum);
4545 }
4546 else
4547 {
4548 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4549 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4550 }
4551
4552 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4553 there have been breakpoints? */
4554 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4555 }
4556
4557 static void
4558 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4559 {
4560 int bnum = -1;
4561
4562 if (bnum_exp)
4563 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4564
4565 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4566 }
4567
4568 static void
4569 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4570 {
4571 int bnum = -1;
4572
4573 if (bnum_exp)
4574 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4575
4576 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4577 }
4578
4579 static int
4580 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4581 struct program_space *pspace,
4582 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4583 {
4584 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4585 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4586 {
4587 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4588 && bl->address == pc
4589 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4590 return 1;
4591 }
4592 return 0;
4593 }
4594
4595 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4596 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4597 address spaces. */
4598
4599 static void
4600 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4601 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4602 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4603 {
4604 int others = 0;
4605 struct breakpoint *b;
4606
4607 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4608 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4609 if (others > 0)
4610 {
4611 if (others == 1)
4612 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4613 else /* if (others == ???) */
4614 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4615 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4616 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4617 {
4618 others--;
4619 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4620 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4621 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4622 else if (b->thread != -1)
4623 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4624 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4625 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4626 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4627 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4628 ? " (disabled)"
4629 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4630 ? " (permanent)"
4631 : ""),
4632 (others > 1) ? ","
4633 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4634 }
4635 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4636 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4637 printf_filtered (".\n");
4638 }
4639 }
4640 \f
4641 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4642 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4643
4644 void
4645 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4646 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4647 int line)
4648 {
4649 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4650 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4651 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4652 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4653 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4654 }
4655
4656 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4657 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4658 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4659 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4660
4661 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4662 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4663 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4664
4665 bp_watchpoint
4666 bp_catchpoint
4667
4668 */
4669
4670 static int
4671 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4672 {
4673 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4674
4675 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4676 }
4677
4678 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4679 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4680
4681 static int
4682 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4683 {
4684 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4685 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4686 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4687 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4688 }
4689
4690 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4691 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4692 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4693 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4694
4695 static int
4696 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4697 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4698 {
4699 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4700 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4701 && addr1 == addr2);
4702 }
4703
4704 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4705 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4706 represent the same location. */
4707
4708 static int
4709 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4710 {
4711 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4712 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4713
4714 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4715 return 0;
4716 else if (hw_point1)
4717 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4718 else
4719 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4720 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4721 }
4722
4723 static void
4724 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4725 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4726 {
4727 char astr1[40];
4728 char astr2[40];
4729
4730 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4731 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4732 if (have_bnum)
4733 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4734 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4735 else
4736 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4737 }
4738
4739 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4740 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4741 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4742 this function is simply the identity function. */
4743
4744 static CORE_ADDR
4745 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4746 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4747 {
4748 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4749 {
4750 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4751 return bpaddr;
4752 }
4753 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4754 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4755 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4756 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4757 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4758 {
4759 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4760 have their addresses modified. */
4761 return bpaddr;
4762 }
4763 else
4764 {
4765 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4766
4767 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4768 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4769 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4770
4771 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4772 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4773 is required. */
4774 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4775 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4776
4777 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4778 }
4779 }
4780
4781 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4782
4783 static struct bp_location *
4784 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4785 {
4786 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4787
4788 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4789 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4790
4791 loc->owner = bpt;
4792 loc->cond = NULL;
4793 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4794 loc->enabled = 1;
4795
4796 switch (bpt->type)
4797 {
4798 case bp_breakpoint:
4799 case bp_tracepoint:
4800 case bp_until:
4801 case bp_finish:
4802 case bp_longjmp:
4803 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4804 case bp_step_resume:
4805 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4806 case bp_call_dummy:
4807 case bp_shlib_event:
4808 case bp_thread_event:
4809 case bp_overlay_event:
4810 case bp_jit_event:
4811 case bp_longjmp_master:
4812 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4813 break;
4814 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4815 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4816 break;
4817 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4818 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4819 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4820 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4821 break;
4822 case bp_watchpoint:
4823 case bp_catchpoint:
4824 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4825 break;
4826 default:
4827 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4828 }
4829
4830 return loc;
4831 }
4832
4833 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4834 {
4835 if (loc->cond)
4836 xfree (loc->cond);
4837
4838 if (loc->function_name)
4839 xfree (loc->function_name);
4840
4841 xfree (loc);
4842 }
4843
4844 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4845 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4846 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4847
4848 static struct breakpoint *
4849 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4850 enum bptype bptype)
4851 {
4852 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4853
4854 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4855 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4856
4857 b->type = bptype;
4858 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4859 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4860 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4861 b->thread = -1;
4862 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4863 b->next = 0;
4864 b->silent = 0;
4865 b->ignore_count = 0;
4866 b->commands = NULL;
4867 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4868 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4869 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4870 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4871 b->ops = NULL;
4872 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4873
4874 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4875 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4876 of increasing numbers. */
4877
4878 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4879 if (b1 == 0)
4880 breakpoint_chain = b;
4881 else
4882 {
4883 while (b1->next)
4884 b1 = b1->next;
4885 b1->next = b;
4886 }
4887 return b;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
4891 static void
4892 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4893 {
4894 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4895 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4896 || loc->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
4897 {
4898 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4899 NULL, NULL);
4900 if (loc->function_name)
4901 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4902 }
4903 }
4904
4905 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
4906 static struct gdbarch *
4907 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4908 {
4909 if (sal.section)
4910 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4911 if (sal.symtab)
4912 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4913
4914 return NULL;
4915 }
4916
4917 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4918 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
4919 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4920 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
4921 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4922 is also returned as the value of this function.
4923
4924 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4925 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4926 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
4927 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4928 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4929 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
4930 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
4931
4932 struct breakpoint *
4933 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4934 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4935 {
4936 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4937 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4938 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4939
4940 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4941 if (!loc_gdbarch)
4942 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4943
4944 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4945 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4946
4947 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4948 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4949 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
4950 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4951 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4952 location that's only been partially initialized. */
4953 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4954
4955 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4956 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4957 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4958 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4959 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4960
4961 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4962 breakpoint resetting. */
4963 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4964
4965 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4966 b->source_file = NULL;
4967 else
4968 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4969 b->loc->section = sal.section;
4970 b->line_number = sal.line;
4971
4972 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4973
4974 breakpoints_changed ();
4975
4976 return b;
4977 }
4978
4979
4980 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4981 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
4982 void
4983 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
4984 {
4985 struct bp_location *bl;
4986 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
4987
4988 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
4989 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
4990 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
4991 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
4992 but it's easy to implmement. */
4993 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
4994 bl->inserted = 1;
4995 }
4996
4997 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
4998 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
4999 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5000
5001 void
5002 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5003 {
5004 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5005
5006 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5007 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5008 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5009 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5010 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5011 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5012 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5013 {
5014 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5015 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5016 clone->thread = thread;
5017 }
5018 }
5019
5020 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5021 void
5022 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5023 {
5024 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5025
5026 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5027 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5028 {
5029 if (b->thread == thread)
5030 delete_breakpoint (b);
5031 }
5032 }
5033
5034 void
5035 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5036 {
5037 struct breakpoint *b;
5038
5039 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5040 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5041 {
5042 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5043 update_global_location_list (1);
5044 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5045 }
5046 }
5047
5048 void
5049 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5050 {
5051 struct breakpoint *b;
5052
5053 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5054 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5055 {
5056 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5057 update_global_location_list (0);
5058 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5059 }
5060 }
5061
5062 struct breakpoint *
5063 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5064 {
5065 struct breakpoint *b;
5066
5067 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5068
5069 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5070 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5071 b->addr_string
5072 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5073
5074 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5075
5076 return b;
5077 }
5078
5079 void
5080 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5081 {
5082 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5083
5084 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5085 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5086 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5087 delete_breakpoint (b);
5088 }
5089
5090 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5091 {
5092 char **arg_p;
5093 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5094 char ***addr_string_p;
5095 int *not_found_ptr;
5096 };
5097
5098 struct lang_and_radix
5099 {
5100 enum language lang;
5101 int radix;
5102 };
5103
5104 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5105
5106 struct breakpoint *
5107 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5108 {
5109 struct breakpoint *b;
5110
5111 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5112 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5113 return b;
5114 }
5115
5116 void
5117 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5118 {
5119 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5120
5121 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5122 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5123 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5124 delete_breakpoint (b);
5125 }
5126
5127 struct breakpoint *
5128 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5129 {
5130 struct breakpoint *b;
5131
5132 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5133 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5134 return b;
5135 }
5136
5137 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5138 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5139
5140 void
5141 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5142 {
5143 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5144
5145 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5146 {
5147 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5148 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5149 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5150 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5151 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5152 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5153 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5154 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5155 || (b->type == bp_tracepoint))
5156 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5157 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5158 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5159 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5160 #else
5161 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5162 #endif
5163 )
5164 {
5165 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5166 }
5167 }
5168 }
5169
5170 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5171 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5172
5173 static void
5174 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5175 {
5176 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5177 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5178
5179 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5180 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5181 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5182 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5183 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5184 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5185 return;
5186
5187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5188 {
5189 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5190 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5191 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5192 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5193 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5194 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5195 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5196 {
5197 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5198 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5199 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5200 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5201 loc->inserted = 0;
5202 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5203 {
5204 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5205 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5206 solib->so_name);
5207 }
5208 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5209 }
5210 }
5211 }
5212
5213 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5214
5215 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5216
5217 static void
5218 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5219 {
5220 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5221 }
5222
5223 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5224
5225 static int
5226 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5227 {
5228 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5232 catchpoints. */
5233
5234 static int
5235 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5236 {
5237 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5238 }
5239
5240 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5241
5242 static enum print_stop_action
5243 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5244 {
5245 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5246 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5247 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5248 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5249 }
5250
5251 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5252
5253 static void
5254 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5255 {
5256 struct value_print_options opts;
5257
5258 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5259
5260 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5261 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5262 is relatively readable). */
5263 if (opts.addressprint)
5264 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5265 annotate_field (5);
5266 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5267 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5268 {
5269 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5270 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5271 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5272 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5273 }
5274 }
5275
5276 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5277 catchpoints. */
5278
5279 static void
5280 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5281 {
5282 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5283 }
5284
5285 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5286
5287 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5288 {
5289 insert_catch_fork,
5290 remove_catch_fork,
5291 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5292 print_it_catch_fork,
5293 print_one_catch_fork,
5294 print_mention_catch_fork
5295 };
5296
5297 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5298
5299 static void
5300 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5301 {
5302 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5303 }
5304
5305 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5306
5307 static int
5308 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5309 {
5310 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5311 }
5312
5313 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5314 catchpoints. */
5315
5316 static int
5317 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5318 {
5319 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5323
5324 static enum print_stop_action
5325 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5326 {
5327 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5328 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5329 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5330 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5334
5335 static void
5336 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5337 {
5338 struct value_print_options opts;
5339
5340 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5341 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5342 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5343 is relatively readable). */
5344 if (opts.addressprint)
5345 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5346 annotate_field (5);
5347 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5348 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5349 {
5350 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5351 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5352 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5353 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5354 }
5355 }
5356
5357 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5358 catchpoints. */
5359
5360 static void
5361 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5362 {
5363 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5364 }
5365
5366 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5367
5368 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5369 {
5370 insert_catch_vfork,
5371 remove_catch_vfork,
5372 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5373 print_it_catch_vfork,
5374 print_one_catch_vfork,
5375 print_mention_catch_vfork
5376 };
5377
5378 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5379 catchpoints. */
5380
5381 static void
5382 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5383 {
5384 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5385
5386 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5387 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5388 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5389 else
5390 {
5391 int i, iter;
5392 for (i = 0;
5393 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5394 i++)
5395 {
5396 int elem;
5397 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5398 {
5399 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5400 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5401 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5402 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5403 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5404 vec_addr_offset;
5405 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5406 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5407 }
5408 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5409 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5410 }
5411 }
5412
5413 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5414 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5415 inf->any_syscall_count,
5416 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5417 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5418 }
5419
5420 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5421 catchpoints. */
5422
5423 static int
5424 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5425 {
5426 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5427
5428 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5429 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5430 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5431 else
5432 {
5433 int i, iter;
5434 for (i = 0;
5435 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5436 i++)
5437 {
5438 int elem;
5439 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5440 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5441 continue;
5442 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5443 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5444 }
5445 }
5446
5447 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5448 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5449 inf->any_syscall_count,
5450 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5451 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5452 }
5453
5454 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5455 catchpoints. */
5456
5457 static int
5458 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5459 {
5460 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5461 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5462 syscall we are catching. */
5463 int syscall_number = 0;
5464
5465 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5466 return 0;
5467
5468 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5469 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5470 {
5471 int i, iter;
5472 for (i = 0;
5473 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5474 i++)
5475 if (syscall_number == iter)
5476 break;
5477 /* Not the same. */
5478 if (!iter)
5479 return 0;
5480 }
5481
5482 return 1;
5483 }
5484
5485 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5486 catchpoints. */
5487
5488 static enum print_stop_action
5489 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5490 {
5491 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5492 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5493 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5494 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5495 ptid_t ptid;
5496 struct target_waitstatus last;
5497 struct syscall s;
5498 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5499 char *syscall_id;
5500
5501 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5502
5503 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5504
5505 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5506
5507 if (s.name == NULL)
5508 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5509 else
5510 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5511
5512 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5513
5514 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5515 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5516 b->number, syscall_id);
5517 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5518 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5519 b->number, syscall_id);
5520
5521 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5522
5523 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5524 }
5525
5526 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5527 catchpoints. */
5528
5529 static void
5530 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5531 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5532 {
5533 struct value_print_options opts;
5534
5535 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5536 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5537 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5538 is relatively readable). */
5539 if (opts.addressprint)
5540 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5541 annotate_field (5);
5542
5543 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5544 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5545 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5546 else
5547 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5548
5549 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5550 {
5551 int i, iter;
5552 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5553 for (i = 0;
5554 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5555 i++)
5556 {
5557 char *x = text;
5558 struct syscall s;
5559 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5560
5561 if (s.name != NULL)
5562 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5563 else
5564 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5565
5566 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5567 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5568 on every call. */
5569 xfree (x);
5570 }
5571 /* Remove the last comma. */
5572 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5573 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5574 }
5575 else
5576 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5577 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5578 }
5579
5580 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5581 catchpoints. */
5582
5583 static void
5584 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5585 {
5586 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5587 {
5588 int i, iter;
5589
5590 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5591 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5592 else
5593 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5594
5595 for (i = 0;
5596 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5597 i++)
5598 {
5599 struct syscall s;
5600 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5601
5602 if (s.name)
5603 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5604 else
5605 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5606 }
5607 printf_filtered (")");
5608 }
5609 else
5610 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5611 b->number);
5612 }
5613
5614 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5615
5616 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5617 {
5618 insert_catch_syscall,
5619 remove_catch_syscall,
5620 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5621 print_it_catch_syscall,
5622 print_one_catch_syscall,
5623 print_mention_catch_syscall
5624 };
5625
5626 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5627
5628 static int
5629 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5630 {
5631 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5632 }
5633
5634 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5635 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5636 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5637 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5638
5639 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5640 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5641 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5642 to the catchpoint. */
5643
5644 static struct breakpoint *
5645 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5646 char *cond_string,
5647 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5648 {
5649 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5650 struct breakpoint *b;
5651
5652 init_sal (&sal);
5653 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5654
5655 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5656 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5657 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5658
5659 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5660 b->thread = -1;
5661 b->addr_string = NULL;
5662 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5663 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5664 b->ops = ops;
5665
5666 return b;
5667 }
5668
5669 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5670
5671 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5672 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5673 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5674 to the catchpoint. */
5675
5676 static struct breakpoint *
5677 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5678 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5679 {
5680 struct breakpoint *b =
5681 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5682
5683 mention (b);
5684 update_global_location_list (1);
5685
5686 return b;
5687 }
5688
5689 static void
5690 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5691 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5692 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5693 {
5694 struct breakpoint *b
5695 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5696
5697 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5698 area. */
5699 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5700 }
5701
5702 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5703
5704 static void
5705 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5706 {
5707 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5708 }
5709
5710 static int
5711 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5712 {
5713 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5714 }
5715
5716 static int
5717 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5718 {
5719 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5720 }
5721
5722 static enum print_stop_action
5723 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5724 {
5725 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5726 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5727 b->exec_pathname);
5728 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5729 }
5730
5731 static void
5732 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5733 {
5734 struct value_print_options opts;
5735
5736 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5737
5738 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5739 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5740 is relatively readable). */
5741 if (opts.addressprint)
5742 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5743 annotate_field (5);
5744 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5745 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5746 {
5747 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5748 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5749 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5750 }
5751 }
5752
5753 static void
5754 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5755 {
5756 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5757 }
5758
5759 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5760 {
5761 insert_catch_exec,
5762 remove_catch_exec,
5763 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5764 print_it_catch_exec,
5765 print_one_catch_exec,
5766 print_mention_catch_exec
5767 };
5768
5769 static void
5770 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5771 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5772 {
5773 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5774 struct breakpoint *b =
5775 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5776
5777 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5778
5779 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5780 location list. */
5781 mention (b);
5782 update_global_location_list (1);
5783 }
5784
5785 static int
5786 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5787 {
5788 struct breakpoint *b;
5789 int i = 0;
5790
5791 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5792 {
5793 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5794 i++;
5795 }
5796
5797 return i;
5798 }
5799
5800 static int
5801 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5802 {
5803 struct breakpoint *b;
5804 int i = 0;
5805
5806 *other_type_used = 0;
5807 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5808 {
5809 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5810 {
5811 if (b->type == type)
5812 i++;
5813 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5814 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5815 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5816 *other_type_used = 1;
5817 }
5818 }
5819 return i;
5820 }
5821
5822 void
5823 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5824 {
5825 struct breakpoint *b;
5826
5827 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5828 {
5829 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5830 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5831 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5832 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5833 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5834 {
5835 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5836 update_global_location_list (0);
5837 }
5838 }
5839 }
5840
5841 void
5842 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5843 {
5844 struct breakpoint *b;
5845
5846 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5847 {
5848 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5849 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5850 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5851 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5852 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5853 {
5854 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5855 update_global_location_list (1);
5856 }
5857 }
5858 }
5859
5860 void
5861 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5862 {
5863 struct breakpoint *b;
5864 int found = 0;
5865
5866 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5867 {
5868 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5869 continue;
5870
5871 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5872 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5873 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5874 {
5875 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5876 found = 1;
5877 }
5878 }
5879
5880 if (found)
5881 update_global_location_list (0);
5882
5883 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5884 }
5885
5886 void
5887 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5888 {
5889 struct breakpoint *b;
5890 int found = 0;
5891
5892 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5893
5894 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5895 {
5896 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5897 continue;
5898
5899 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5900 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5901 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5902 {
5903 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5904 found = 1;
5905 }
5906 }
5907
5908 if (found)
5909 breakpoint_re_set ();
5910 }
5911
5912
5913 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5914 at address specified by SAL.
5915 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
5916
5917 struct breakpoint *
5918 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5919 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5920 {
5921 struct breakpoint *b;
5922
5923 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5924 one. */
5925 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5926
5927 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5928 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5929 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5930 b->frame_id = frame_id;
5931
5932 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5933 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5934 single thread of control. */
5935 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5936 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5937
5938 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5939
5940 return b;
5941 }
5942
5943 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
5944 ORIG is NULL. */
5945
5946 struct breakpoint *
5947 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5948 {
5949 struct breakpoint *copy;
5950
5951 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
5952 if (orig == NULL)
5953 return NULL;
5954
5955 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5956 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5957 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5958
5959 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5960 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5961 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5962 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5963 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5964
5965 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5966 copy->source_file = NULL;
5967 else
5968 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5969
5970 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5971 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5972 copy->thread = orig->thread;
5973 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5974
5975 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5976 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5977 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5978
5979 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5980 return copy;
5981 }
5982
5983 struct breakpoint *
5984 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
5985 enum bptype type)
5986 {
5987 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5988
5989 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
5990 sal.pc = pc;
5991 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
5992 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
5993
5994 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
5995 }
5996 \f
5997
5998 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
5999
6000 static void
6001 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6002 {
6003 int say_where = 0;
6004 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6005 struct value_print_options opts;
6006
6007 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6008
6009 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6010 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6011 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6012 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6013 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6014
6015 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6016 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6017 else
6018 switch (b->type)
6019 {
6020 case bp_none:
6021 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6022 break;
6023 case bp_watchpoint:
6024 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6025 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6026 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6027 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6028 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6029 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6030 break;
6031 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6032 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6033 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6034 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6035 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6036 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6037 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6038 break;
6039 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6040 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6041 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6042 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6043 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6044 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6045 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6046 break;
6047 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6048 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6049 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6050 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6051 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6052 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6053 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6054 break;
6055 case bp_breakpoint:
6056 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6057 {
6058 say_where = 0;
6059 break;
6060 }
6061 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6062 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6063 else
6064 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6065 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6066 say_where = 1;
6067 break;
6068 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6069 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6070 {
6071 say_where = 0;
6072 break;
6073 }
6074 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6075 say_where = 1;
6076 break;
6077 case bp_tracepoint:
6078 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6079 {
6080 say_where = 0;
6081 break;
6082 }
6083 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6084 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6085 say_where = 1;
6086 break;
6087
6088 case bp_until:
6089 case bp_finish:
6090 case bp_longjmp:
6091 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6092 case bp_step_resume:
6093 case bp_call_dummy:
6094 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6095 case bp_shlib_event:
6096 case bp_thread_event:
6097 case bp_overlay_event:
6098 case bp_jit_event:
6099 case bp_longjmp_master:
6100 break;
6101 }
6102
6103 if (say_where)
6104 {
6105 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6106 single string. */
6107 if (b->loc == NULL)
6108 {
6109 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6110 }
6111 else
6112 {
6113 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6114 {
6115 printf_filtered (" at ");
6116 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6117 gdb_stdout);
6118 }
6119 if (b->source_file)
6120 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6121 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6122
6123 if (b->loc->next)
6124 {
6125 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6126 int n = 0;
6127 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6128 ++n;
6129 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6130 }
6131
6132 }
6133 }
6134 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6135 return;
6136 printf_filtered ("\n");
6137 }
6138 \f
6139
6140 static struct bp_location *
6141 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6142 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6143 {
6144 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6145
6146 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6147 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6148 ;
6149 *tmp = loc;
6150 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6151 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6152 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6153 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6154 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6155 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6156 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6157 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6158 loc->section = sal->section;
6159
6160 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6161 return loc;
6162 }
6163 \f
6164
6165 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6166 return 0 otherwise. */
6167
6168 static int
6169 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6170 {
6171 int len;
6172 CORE_ADDR addr;
6173 const gdb_byte *brk;
6174 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6175 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6176 int retval = 0;
6177
6178 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6179
6180 addr = loc->address;
6181 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6182
6183 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6184 if (brk == NULL)
6185 return 0;
6186
6187 target_mem = alloca (len);
6188
6189 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6190 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6191 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6192 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6193
6194 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6195 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6196
6197 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6198 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6199 retval = 1;
6200
6201 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6202
6203 return retval;
6204 }
6205
6206
6207
6208 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6209 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6210 as condition expression. */
6211
6212 static void
6213 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6214 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6215 char *cond_string,
6216 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6217 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6218 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6219 {
6220 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6221 int i;
6222
6223 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6224 {
6225 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6226 int target_resources_ok =
6227 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6228 i + 1, 0);
6229 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6230 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6231 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6232 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6233 }
6234
6235 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6236
6237 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6238 {
6239 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6240 struct bp_location *loc;
6241
6242 if (from_tty)
6243 {
6244 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6245 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6246 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6247
6248 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6249 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6250 }
6251
6252 if (i == 0)
6253 {
6254 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6255 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6256 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6257 b->thread = thread;
6258 b->task = task;
6259
6260 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6261 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6262 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6263 b->disposition = disposition;
6264
6265 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6266
6267 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6268 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6269 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6270 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6271
6272 loc = b->loc;
6273 }
6274 else
6275 {
6276 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6277 }
6278
6279 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6280 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6281
6282 if (b->cond_string)
6283 {
6284 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6285 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6286 if (*arg)
6287 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6288 }
6289 }
6290
6291 if (addr_string)
6292 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6293 else
6294 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6295 me. */
6296 b->addr_string
6297 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6298
6299 b->ops = ops;
6300 mention (b);
6301 }
6302
6303 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6304 elements to fill the void space. */
6305 static void
6306 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6307 {
6308 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6309 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6310
6311 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6312 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6313
6314 --(sal->nelts);
6315 }
6316
6317 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6318 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6319 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6320 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6321 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6322 single expanded sal, return the original.
6323
6324 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6325 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6326 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6327 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6328 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6329
6330 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6331 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6332 {
6333 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6334 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6335 char *original_function = NULL;
6336 int found;
6337 int i;
6338 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6339
6340 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6341 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6342 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6343 {
6344 expanded.nelts = 1;
6345 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6346 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6347 return expanded;
6348 }
6349
6350 sal.pc = 0;
6351
6352 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6353
6354 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6355
6356 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6357
6358 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6359 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6360
6361 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6362 {
6363 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6364 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6365 xfree (expanded.sals);
6366 expanded.nelts = 1;
6367 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6368 sal.pc = original_pc;
6369 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6370 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6371 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6372 return expanded;
6373 }
6374
6375 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6376 {
6377 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6378 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6379 {
6380 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6381 char *this_function;
6382
6383 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6384 read memory. */
6385 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6386
6387 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6388 &func_addr, &func_end))
6389 {
6390 if (this_function
6391 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6392 {
6393 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6394 --i;
6395 }
6396 else if (func_addr == pc)
6397 {
6398 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6399 skip prologue. */
6400 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6401 if (sym)
6402 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6403 else
6404 {
6405 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6406 we should really always find the section here. */
6407 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6408 if (section)
6409 {
6410 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6411 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6412 expanded.sals[i].pc
6413 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6414 }
6415 }
6416 }
6417 }
6418 }
6419 }
6420 else
6421 {
6422 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6423 {
6424 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6425 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6426 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6427 }
6428 }
6429
6430 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6431
6432 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6433 {
6434 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6435 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6436 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6437 xfree (expanded.sals);
6438 expanded.nelts = 1;
6439 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6440 sal.pc = original_pc;
6441 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6442 return expanded;
6443 }
6444
6445 if (original_pc)
6446 {
6447 found = 0;
6448 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6449 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6450 {
6451 found = 1;
6452 break;
6453 }
6454 gdb_assert (found);
6455 }
6456
6457 return expanded;
6458 }
6459
6460 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6461 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6462 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6463 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6464 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6465 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6466 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6467 we take just a single condition string.
6468
6469 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6470 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6471 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6472 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6473 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6474
6475 static void
6476 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6477 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6478 char *cond_string,
6479 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6480 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6481 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6482 int enabled)
6483 {
6484 int i;
6485 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6486 {
6487 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6488 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6489
6490 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6491 cond_string, type, disposition,
6492 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6493 }
6494 }
6495
6496 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6497 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6498 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6499 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6500
6501 static void
6502 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6503 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6504 char ***addr_string,
6505 int *not_found_ptr)
6506 {
6507 char *addr_start = *address;
6508 *addr_string = NULL;
6509 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6510 breakpoint. */
6511 if ((*address) == NULL
6512 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6513 {
6514 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6515 {
6516 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6517 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6518 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6519 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6520 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6521 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6522 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6523 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6524 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6525
6526 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6527 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6528 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6529 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6530 */
6531 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6532
6533 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6534 sals->nelts = 1;
6535 }
6536 else
6537 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6538 }
6539 else
6540 {
6541 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6542 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6543 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6544 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6545 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6546 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6547
6548 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6549
6550 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6551 && (!cursal.symtab
6552 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6553 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6554 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6555 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6556 not_found_ptr);
6557 else
6558 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6559 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6560 }
6561 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6562 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6563 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6564 if (addr_start != (*address))
6565 {
6566 int i;
6567 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6568 {
6569 /* Add the string if not present. */
6570 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6571 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6572 }
6573 }
6574 }
6575
6576
6577 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6578 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6579
6580 static void
6581 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6582 char *address)
6583 {
6584 int i;
6585 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6586 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6587 }
6588
6589 static void
6590 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6591 {
6592 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6593
6594 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6595 args->not_found_ptr);
6596 }
6597
6598 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6599 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6600 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6601 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6602 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6603 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6604 static void
6605 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6606 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6607 {
6608 *cond_string = NULL;
6609 *thread = -1;
6610 while (tok && *tok)
6611 {
6612 char *end_tok;
6613 int toklen;
6614 char *cond_start = NULL;
6615 char *cond_end = NULL;
6616 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6617 tok++;
6618
6619 end_tok = tok;
6620
6621 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6622 end_tok++;
6623
6624 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6625
6626 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6627 {
6628 struct expression *expr;
6629
6630 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6631 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6632 xfree (expr);
6633 cond_end = tok;
6634 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6635 cond_end - cond_start);
6636 }
6637 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6638 {
6639 char *tmptok;
6640
6641 tok = end_tok + 1;
6642 tmptok = tok;
6643 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6644 if (tok == tmptok)
6645 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6646 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6647 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6648 }
6649 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6650 {
6651 char *tmptok;
6652
6653 tok = end_tok + 1;
6654 tmptok = tok;
6655 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6656 if (tok == tmptok)
6657 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6658 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6659 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6660 }
6661 else
6662 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6663 }
6664 }
6665
6666 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between
6667 CLI and MI functions for setting a breakpoint.
6668 This function has two major modes of operations,
6669 selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD parameter.
6670 If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6671 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise,
6672 ARG is just the location of breakpoint, with condition
6673 and thread specified by the COND_STRING and THREAD
6674 parameters. */
6675
6676 static void
6677 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6678 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6679 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6680 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6681 int ignore_count,
6682 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6683 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6684 int from_tty,
6685 int enabled)
6686 {
6687 struct gdb_exception e;
6688 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6689 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6690 char *copy_arg;
6691 char *err_msg;
6692 char *addr_start = arg;
6693 char **addr_string;
6694 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6695 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6696 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6697 int i;
6698 int pending = 0;
6699 int not_found = 0;
6700 enum bptype type_wanted;
6701 int task = 0;
6702
6703 sals.sals = NULL;
6704 sals.nelts = 0;
6705 addr_string = NULL;
6706
6707 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6708 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6709 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6710 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6711
6712 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6713 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6714
6715 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6716 switch (e.reason)
6717 {
6718 case RETURN_QUIT:
6719 throw_exception (e);
6720 case RETURN_ERROR:
6721 switch (e.error)
6722 {
6723 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6724
6725 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6726 error. */
6727
6728 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6729 throw_exception (e);
6730
6731 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6732
6733 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6734 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6735 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6736 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6737 return;
6738
6739 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6740 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6741 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6742 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6743 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6744 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6745 sals.nelts = 1;
6746 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6747 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6748 pending = 1;
6749 break;
6750 default:
6751 throw_exception (e);
6752 }
6753 default:
6754 if (!sals.nelts)
6755 return;
6756 }
6757
6758 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6759 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6760
6761 if (!pending)
6762 {
6763 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6764 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6765
6766 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6767 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6768 }
6769
6770 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6771 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6772 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6773 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6774 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6775
6776 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6777 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6778 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6779 {
6780 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6781 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6782 }
6783
6784 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6785 are ok for the target. */
6786 if (!pending)
6787 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6788
6789 type_wanted = (traceflag
6790 ? bp_tracepoint
6791 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6792
6793 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6794 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6795 breakpoint. */
6796 if (!pending)
6797 {
6798 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6799 {
6800 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6801 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6802 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6803 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6804 cond_string = NULL;
6805 thread = -1;
6806 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6807 &thread, &task);
6808 if (cond_string)
6809 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6810 }
6811 else
6812 {
6813 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6814 if (cond_string)
6815 {
6816 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6817 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6818 }
6819 }
6820 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6821 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6822 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6823 }
6824 else
6825 {
6826 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6827 struct breakpoint *b;
6828
6829 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6830
6831 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6832 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6833 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6834 b->thread = -1;
6835 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6836 b->cond_string = NULL;
6837 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6838 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6839 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6840 b->ops = ops;
6841 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6842 b->pspace = current_program_space;
6843
6844 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6845 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6846 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6847 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6848
6849 mention (b);
6850 }
6851
6852 if (sals.nelts > 1)
6853 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6854 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6855 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6856 breakpoint. */
6857 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6858 /* But cleanup everything else. */
6859 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6860
6861 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
6862 update_global_location_list (1);
6863 }
6864
6865 /* Set a breakpoint.
6866 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6867 condition, and thread.
6868 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6869 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6870 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
6871
6872 static void
6873 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6874 {
6875 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6876 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6877
6878 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6879 arg,
6880 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6881 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6882 0 /* Ignore count */,
6883 pending_break_support,
6884 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6885 from_tty,
6886 1 /* enabled */);
6887 }
6888
6889
6890 void
6891 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6892 char *address, char *condition,
6893 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6894 int thread, int ignore_count,
6895 int pending, int enabled)
6896 {
6897 break_command_really (gdbarch,
6898 address, condition, thread,
6899 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
6900 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6901 ignore_count,
6902 pending
6903 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6904 NULL, 0, enabled);
6905 }
6906
6907 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6908 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6909 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6910 not modified.
6911
6912 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
6913
6914 static void
6915 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6916 {
6917 struct symbol *sym;
6918 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6919 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6920
6921 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6922
6923 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6924 if (sym != NULL)
6925 {
6926 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6927 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6928 {
6929 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6930 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6931 *sal = start_sal;
6932 }
6933 }
6934
6935 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6936 }
6937
6938 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
6939
6940 void
6941 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6942 {
6943 CORE_ADDR pc;
6944
6945 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6946 {
6947 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
6948 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
6949 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
6950 sal->pc = pc;
6951
6952 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
6953 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6954 if (sal->explicit_line)
6955 {
6956 /* Preserve the original line number. */
6957 int saved_line = sal->line;
6958 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
6959 sal->line = saved_line;
6960 }
6961 }
6962
6963 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6964 {
6965 struct blockvector *bv;
6966 struct block *b;
6967 struct symbol *sym;
6968
6969 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
6970 if (bv != NULL)
6971 {
6972 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
6973 if (sym != NULL)
6974 {
6975 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
6976 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
6977 }
6978 else
6979 {
6980 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
6981 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
6982 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
6983 source). */
6984
6985 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
6986 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6987
6988 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
6989
6990 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
6991 if (msym)
6992 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
6993
6994 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6995 }
6996 }
6997 }
6998 }
6999
7000 void
7001 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7002 {
7003 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7004 }
7005
7006 void
7007 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7008 {
7009 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7010 }
7011
7012 static void
7013 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7014 {
7015 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7016 }
7017
7018 static void
7019 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7020 {
7021 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7022 }
7023
7024 static void
7025 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7026 {
7027 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7028 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7029 stop at <line>\n"));
7030 }
7031
7032 static void
7033 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7034 {
7035 int badInput = 0;
7036
7037 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7038 badInput = 1;
7039 else if (*arg != '*')
7040 {
7041 char *argptr = arg;
7042 int hasColon = 0;
7043
7044 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7045 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7046 function/method name */
7047 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7048 {
7049 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7050 argptr++;
7051 }
7052
7053 if (hasColon)
7054 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7055 else
7056 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7057 }
7058
7059 if (badInput)
7060 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7061 else
7062 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7063 }
7064
7065 static void
7066 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7067 {
7068 int badInput = 0;
7069
7070 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7071 badInput = 1;
7072 else
7073 {
7074 char *argptr = arg;
7075 int hasColon = 0;
7076
7077 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7078 it is probably a line number. */
7079 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7080 {
7081 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7082 argptr++;
7083 }
7084
7085 if (hasColon)
7086 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7087 else
7088 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7089 }
7090
7091 if (badInput)
7092 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7093 else
7094 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7095 }
7096
7097 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7098 hw_read: watch read,
7099 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7100 static void
7101 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7102 {
7103 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7104 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7105 struct expression *exp;
7106 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7107 struct value *val, *mark;
7108 struct frame_info *frame;
7109 char *exp_start = NULL;
7110 char *exp_end = NULL;
7111 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7112 int toklen;
7113 char *cond_start = NULL;
7114 char *cond_end = NULL;
7115 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7116 enum bptype bp_type;
7117 int mem_cnt = 0;
7118 int thread = -1;
7119
7120 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7121 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7122 {
7123 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7124
7125 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7126 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7127
7128 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7129 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7130 be the thread identifier. */
7131 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7132 tok--;
7133 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7134 tok--;
7135
7136 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7137 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7138
7139 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7140 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7141 reach a "thread" token. */
7142 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7143 tok--;
7144
7145 end_tok = tok;
7146
7147 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7148 tok--;
7149
7150 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7151 calculate the length of the token. */
7152 tok++;
7153 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7154
7155 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7156 {
7157 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7158 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7159 only in a specific thread. */
7160 char *endp;
7161
7162 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7163 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7164
7165 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7166 thread ID. */
7167 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7168 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7169
7170 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7171 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7172 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7173
7174 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7175 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7176 evaluate_expression() function. */
7177 *tok = '\0';
7178 }
7179 }
7180
7181 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7182 innermost_block = NULL;
7183 exp_start = arg;
7184 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7185 exp_end = arg;
7186 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7187 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7188 prettier. */
7189 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7190 --exp_end;
7191
7192 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7193 mark = value_mark ();
7194 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7195 if (val != NULL)
7196 release_value (val);
7197
7198 tok = arg;
7199 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7200 tok++;
7201 end_tok = tok;
7202
7203 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7204 end_tok++;
7205
7206 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7207 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7208 {
7209 struct expression *cond;
7210
7211 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7212 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7213 xfree (cond);
7214 cond_end = tok;
7215 }
7216 if (*tok)
7217 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7218
7219 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7220 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7221 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7222 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7223 else
7224 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7225
7226 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7227 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7228 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7229 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7230 {
7231 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7232 target_resources_ok =
7233 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7234 other_type_used);
7235 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7236 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7237
7238 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7239 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7240 }
7241
7242 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7243 watchpoint could not be set. */
7244 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7245 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7246
7247 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7248
7249 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7250 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7251 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7252 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7253 if (innermost_block && frame)
7254 {
7255 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7256 {
7257 scope_breakpoint
7258 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7259 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7260 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7261
7262 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7263
7264 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7265 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7266
7267 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7268 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7269
7270 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7271 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7272 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7273 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7274 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7275 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7276 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7277 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7278 scope_breakpoint->type);
7279 }
7280 }
7281
7282 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7283 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7284 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7285 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7286 b->thread = thread;
7287 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7288 b->exp = exp;
7289 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7290 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7291 b->val = val;
7292 b->val_valid = 1;
7293 if (cond_start)
7294 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7295 else
7296 b->cond_string = 0;
7297
7298 if (frame)
7299 {
7300 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7301 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7302 }
7303 else
7304 {
7305 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7306 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7307 }
7308
7309 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7310 {
7311 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7312 need to act on them together. */
7313 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7314 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7315 }
7316
7317 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7318
7319 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7320 that should be inserted. */
7321 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7322
7323 mention (b);
7324 update_global_location_list (1);
7325 }
7326
7327 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7328 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7329 in hardware return zero. */
7330
7331 static int
7332 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7333 {
7334 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7335 struct value *head = v;
7336
7337 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7338 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7339 return 0;
7340
7341 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7342 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7343 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7344 hardware watchpoint.
7345
7346 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7347 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7348 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7349 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7350 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7351 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7352 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7353 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7354 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7355
7356 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7357 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7358 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7359 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7360 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7361 {
7362 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7363 {
7364 if (value_lazy (v))
7365 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7366 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7367 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7368 ;
7369 else
7370 {
7371 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7372 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7373 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7374
7375 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7376 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7377 middle of some value chain. */
7378 if (v == head
7379 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7380 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7381 {
7382 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7383 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7384
7385 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7386 return 0;
7387 else
7388 found_memory_cnt++;
7389 }
7390 }
7391 }
7392 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7393 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7394 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7395 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7396 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7397 }
7398
7399 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7400 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7401 return found_memory_cnt;
7402 }
7403
7404 void
7405 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7406 {
7407 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7408 }
7409
7410 static void
7411 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7412 {
7413 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7414 }
7415
7416 void
7417 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7418 {
7419 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7420 }
7421
7422 static void
7423 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7424 {
7425 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7426 }
7427
7428 void
7429 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7430 {
7431 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7432 }
7433
7434 static void
7435 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7436 {
7437 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7438 }
7439 \f
7440
7441 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7442 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7443
7444 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7445 {
7446 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7447 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7448 };
7449
7450 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7451 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7452 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7453 command. */
7454 static void
7455 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7456 {
7457 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7458
7459 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7460 if (a->breakpoint2)
7461 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7462 }
7463
7464 void
7465 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7466 {
7467 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7468 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7469 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7470 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7471 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7472 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7473
7474 clear_proceed_status ();
7475
7476 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7477 this function */
7478
7479 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7480 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7481 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7482 else
7483 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7484 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7485
7486 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7487 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7488
7489 sal = sals.sals[0];
7490 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7491
7492 if (*arg)
7493 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7494
7495 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7496
7497 if (anywhere)
7498 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7499 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7500 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7501 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7502 else
7503 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7504 at the very same frame. */
7505 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7506 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7507 bp_until);
7508
7509 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7510
7511 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7512 one. */
7513
7514 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7515 {
7516 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7517 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7518 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7519 sal,
7520 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7521 bp_until);
7522 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7523 }
7524
7525 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7526
7527 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7528 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7529 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7530 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7531
7532 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7533 {
7534 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7535 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7536
7537 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7538 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7539
7540 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7541 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7542 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7543 xfree);
7544 }
7545 else
7546 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7547 }
7548
7549 static void
7550 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7551 {
7552 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7553 return;
7554 while (isspace (**s))
7555 *s += 1;
7556 }
7557
7558 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7559 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7560
7561 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7562 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7563 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7564 if clause in the arg string. */
7565
7566 static char *
7567 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7568 {
7569 char *cond_string;
7570
7571 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7572 return NULL;
7573
7574 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7575 (*arg) += 2;
7576
7577 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7578 condition string. */
7579 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7580 cond_string = *arg;
7581
7582 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7583 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7584
7585 return cond_string;
7586 }
7587
7588 /* This function attempts to parse an optional filename from the arg
7589 string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7590
7591 Else, it returns a pointer to the parsed filename. (This function
7592 makes no attempt to verify that a file of that name exists, or is
7593 accessible.) And, it updates arg to point to the first character
7594 following the parsed filename in the arg string.
7595
7596 Note that clients needing to preserve the returned filename for
7597 future access should copy it to their own buffers. */
7598 static char *
7599 ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg)
7600 {
7601 static char filename[1024];
7602 char *arg_p = *arg;
7603 int i;
7604 char c;
7605
7606 if ((*arg_p == '\0') || isspace (*arg_p))
7607 return NULL;
7608
7609 for (i = 0;; i++)
7610 {
7611 c = *arg_p;
7612 if (isspace (c))
7613 c = '\0';
7614 filename[i] = c;
7615 if (c == '\0')
7616 break;
7617 arg_p++;
7618 }
7619 *arg = arg_p;
7620
7621 return filename;
7622 }
7623
7624 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7625 process start/exit, etc. */
7626
7627 typedef enum
7628 {
7629 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7630 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7631 }
7632 catch_fork_kind;
7633
7634 static void
7635 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7636 {
7637 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7638 char *cond_string = NULL;
7639 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7640 int tempflag;
7641
7642 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7643 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7644 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7645
7646 if (!arg)
7647 arg = "";
7648 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7649
7650 /* The allowed syntax is:
7651 catch [v]fork
7652 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7653
7654 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7655 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7656
7657 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7658 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7659
7660 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7661 and enable reporting of such events. */
7662 switch (fork_kind)
7663 {
7664 case catch_fork_temporary:
7665 case catch_fork_permanent:
7666 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7667 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7668 break;
7669 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7670 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7671 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7672 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7673 break;
7674 default:
7675 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7676 break;
7677 }
7678 }
7679
7680 static void
7681 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7682 {
7683 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7684 int tempflag;
7685 char *cond_string = NULL;
7686
7687 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7688
7689 if (!arg)
7690 arg = "";
7691 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7692
7693 /* The allowed syntax is:
7694 catch exec
7695 catch exec if <cond>
7696
7697 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7698 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7699
7700 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7701 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7702
7703 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7704 and enable reporting of such events. */
7705 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7706 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7707 }
7708
7709 static enum print_stop_action
7710 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7711 {
7712 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7713
7714 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7715
7716 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7717 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7718 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7719 b->loc->address,
7720 b->number, 1);
7721 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7722 ui_out_text (uiout,
7723 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7724 : "Catchpoint ");
7725 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7726 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7727 ui_out_text (uiout,
7728 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7729 : " (exception caught), ");
7730 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7731 {
7732 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7733 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7734 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7735 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7736 }
7737 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7738 }
7739
7740 static void
7741 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7742 {
7743 struct value_print_options opts;
7744 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7745 if (opts.addressprint)
7746 {
7747 annotate_field (4);
7748 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7749 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7750 else
7751 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7752 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7753 }
7754 annotate_field (5);
7755 if (b->loc)
7756 *last_loc = b->loc;
7757 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7758 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7759 else
7760 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7761 }
7762
7763 static void
7764 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7765 {
7766 int bp_temp;
7767 int bp_throw;
7768
7769 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7770 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7771 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7772 : _("Catchpoint "));
7773 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7774 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7775 : _(" (catch)"));
7776 }
7777
7778 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7779 NULL, /* insert */
7780 NULL, /* remove */
7781 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7782 print_exception_catchpoint,
7783 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7784 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7785 };
7786
7787 static int
7788 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7789 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7790 {
7791 char *trigger_func_name;
7792
7793 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7794 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7795 else
7796 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7797
7798 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7799 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7800 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7801 tempflag, 0, 0,
7802 0,
7803 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7804 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7805 1 /* enabled */);
7806
7807 return 1;
7808 }
7809
7810 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7811
7812 static void
7813 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7814 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7815 {
7816 char *cond_string = NULL;
7817 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7818
7819 if (!arg)
7820 arg = "";
7821 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7822
7823 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7824
7825 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7826 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7827
7828 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7829 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7830 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7831
7832 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7833 return;
7834
7835 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7836 }
7837
7838 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7839
7840 static void
7841 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7842 {
7843 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7844 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7848
7849 static void
7850 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7851 {
7852 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7853 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7854 }
7855
7856 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
7857
7858 static void
7859 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7860 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7861 char *addr_string,
7862 char *exp_string,
7863 char *cond_string,
7864 struct expression *cond,
7865 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7866 int tempflag,
7867 int from_tty)
7868 {
7869 struct breakpoint *b;
7870
7871 if (from_tty)
7872 {
7873 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7874 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7875 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7876
7877 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7878 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7879 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7880 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7881 used for different exception names will use the same address.
7882 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7883 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7884 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7885 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
7886 enough for now, though. */
7887 }
7888
7889 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7890 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7891
7892 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7893 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7894 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7895 b->ignore_count = 0;
7896 b->loc->cond = cond;
7897 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7898 b->language = language_ada;
7899 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7900 b->exp_string = exp_string;
7901 b->thread = -1;
7902 b->ops = ops;
7903
7904 mention (b);
7905 update_global_location_list (1);
7906 }
7907
7908 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
7909
7910 static void
7911 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7912 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7913 {
7914 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7915 int tempflag;
7916 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7917 enum bptype type;
7918 char *addr_string = NULL;
7919 char *exp_string = NULL;
7920 char *cond_string = NULL;
7921 struct expression *cond = NULL;
7922 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7923
7924 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7925
7926 if (!arg)
7927 arg = "";
7928 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7929 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7930 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7931 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7932 from_tty);
7933 }
7934
7935 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
7936 static void
7937 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7938 {
7939 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7940 VEC_free (int, iter);
7941 }
7942
7943 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
7944 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
7945 static VEC(int) *
7946 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7947 {
7948 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7949 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7950
7951 while (*arg != '\0')
7952 {
7953 int i, syscall_number;
7954 char *endptr;
7955 char cur_name[128];
7956 struct syscall s;
7957
7958 /* Skip whitespace. */
7959 while (isspace (*arg))
7960 arg++;
7961
7962 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7963 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7964 cur_name[i] = '\0';
7965 arg += i;
7966
7967 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
7968 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7969 if (*endptr == '\0')
7970 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7971 else
7972 {
7973 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
7974 to a number. */
7975 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
7976
7977 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
7978 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
7979 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
7980 be caught. */
7981 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
7982 }
7983
7984 /* Ok, it's valid. */
7985 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
7986 }
7987
7988 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
7989 return result;
7990 }
7991
7992 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
7993
7994 static void
7995 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7996 {
7997 int tempflag;
7998 VEC(int) *filter;
7999 struct syscall s;
8000 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8001
8002 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8003 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8004 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8005 this architeture yet."));
8006
8007 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8008
8009 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8010
8011 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8012 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8013 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8014 for his/her architecture. */
8015 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8016
8017 /* The allowed syntax is:
8018 catch syscall
8019 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8020
8021 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8022
8023 if (arg != NULL)
8024 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8025 else
8026 filter = NULL;
8027
8028 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8029 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8030 }
8031
8032 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8033
8034 static void
8035 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8036 {
8037 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8038 int tempflag;
8039 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8040 char *addr_string = NULL;
8041 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8042
8043 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8044
8045 if (!arg)
8046 arg = "";
8047 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8048 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8049 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8050 }
8051
8052 static void
8053 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8054 {
8055 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8056 }
8057 \f
8058
8059 static void
8060 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8061 {
8062 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8063 }
8064
8065 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8066
8067 static void
8068 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8069 {
8070 struct breakpoint *b;
8071 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8072 int ix;
8073 int default_match;
8074 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8075 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8076 int i;
8077
8078 if (arg)
8079 {
8080 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8081 default_match = 0;
8082 }
8083 else
8084 {
8085 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8086 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8087 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8088 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8089 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8090 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8091 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8092 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8093 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8094 error (_("No source file specified."));
8095
8096 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8097 sals.nelts = 1;
8098
8099 default_match = 1;
8100 }
8101
8102 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8103 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8104 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8105 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8106 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8107
8108 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8109 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8110 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8111 due to optimization, all in one block.
8112 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8113 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8114 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8115 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8116 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8117 to support that. */
8118
8119 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8120 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8121 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8122 one breakpoint. */
8123
8124 found = NULL;
8125 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8126 {
8127 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8128 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8129 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8130 or at default pc.
8131
8132 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8133
8134 0 1 pc
8135 1 1 pc _and_ line
8136 0 0 line
8137 1 0 <can't happen> */
8138
8139 sal = sals.sals[i];
8140
8141 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8142 'found'. */
8143 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8144 {
8145 int match = 0;
8146 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8147 if (b->type != bp_none
8148 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8149 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8150 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8151 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8152 {
8153 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8154 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8155 {
8156 int pc_match = sal.pc
8157 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8158 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8159 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8160 || loc->section == sal.section);
8161 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8162 && b->source_file != NULL
8163 && sal.symtab != NULL
8164 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8165 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8166 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8167 if (pc_match || line_match)
8168 {
8169 match = 1;
8170 break;
8171 }
8172 }
8173 }
8174
8175 if (match)
8176 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8177 }
8178 }
8179 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8180 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8181 {
8182 if (arg)
8183 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8184 else
8185 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8186 }
8187
8188 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8189 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8190 if (from_tty)
8191 {
8192 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8193 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8194 else
8195 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8196 }
8197 breakpoints_changed ();
8198
8199 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8200 {
8201 if (from_tty)
8202 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8203 delete_breakpoint (b);
8204 }
8205 if (from_tty)
8206 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8207 }
8208 \f
8209 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8210 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8211 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8212
8213 void
8214 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8215 {
8216 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8217
8218 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8219 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8220 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8221 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8222 && bs->stop)
8223 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8224
8225 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8226 {
8227 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8228 delete_breakpoint (b);
8229 }
8230 }
8231
8232 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8233 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8234 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8235 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8236 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8237
8238 static int
8239 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8240 {
8241 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8242 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8243 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8244 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8245
8246 if (a->address != b->address)
8247 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8248
8249 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8250 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8251 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8252
8253 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8254 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8255
8256 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8257 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8258 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8259
8260 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8261 }
8262
8263 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8264 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8265 the bp_location array. */
8266
8267 static void
8268 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8269 {
8270 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8271
8272 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8273 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8274
8275 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8276 {
8277 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8278
8279 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8280 continue;
8281
8282 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8283 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8284
8285 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8286 addr = bl->address - start;
8287 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8288 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8289
8290 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8291
8292 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8293 addr = end - bl->address;
8294 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8295 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8296 }
8297 }
8298
8299 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8300 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8301 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8302 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8303 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8304 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8305 returns true on them.
8306
8307 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8308 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8309 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8310 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8311 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8312 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8313
8314 static void
8315 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8316 {
8317 struct breakpoint *b;
8318 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8319 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8320
8321 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8322 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8323 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8324 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8325 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8326 once. */
8327 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8328 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8329 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8330 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8331
8332 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8333 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8334 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8335 unsigned old_location_count;
8336
8337 old_location = bp_location;
8338 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8339 bp_location = NULL;
8340 bp_location_count = 0;
8341 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8342
8343 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8344 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8345 bp_location_count++;
8346
8347 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8348 locp = bp_location;
8349 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8350 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8351 *locp++ = loc;
8352 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8353 bp_location_compare);
8354
8355 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8356
8357 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8358 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8359 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8360 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8361 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8362
8363 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8364 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8365
8366 locp = bp_location;
8367 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8368 old_locp++)
8369 {
8370 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8371 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8372
8373 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8374 have to free it. */
8375 int found_object = 0;
8376 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8377 int keep_in_target = 0;
8378 int removed = 0;
8379
8380 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8381 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8382 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8383 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8384 locp++;
8385
8386 for (loc2p = locp;
8387 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8388 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8389 loc2p++)
8390 {
8391 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8392 {
8393 found_object = 1;
8394 break;
8395 }
8396 }
8397
8398 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8399 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8400 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8401 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8402 inserted. */
8403
8404 if (old_loc->inserted)
8405 {
8406 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8407
8408 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8409 {
8410 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8411 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8412 keep_in_target = 1;
8413 }
8414 else
8415 {
8416 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8417 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8418 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8419
8420 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8421 {
8422 for (loc2p = locp;
8423 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8424 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8425 loc2p++)
8426 {
8427 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8428
8429 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8430 {
8431 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8432 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8433 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8434 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8435 {
8436 loc2->inserted = 1;
8437 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8438 keep_in_target = 1;
8439 break;
8440 }
8441 }
8442 }
8443 }
8444 }
8445
8446 if (!keep_in_target)
8447 {
8448 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8449 {
8450 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8451 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8452 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8453 succeed next time.
8454
8455 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8456 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8457 after calling us. */
8458 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8459 old_loc->owner->number);
8460 }
8461 removed = 1;
8462 }
8463 }
8464
8465 if (!found_object)
8466 {
8467 if (removed && non_stop
8468 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8469 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8470 {
8471 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8472 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8473 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8474 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8475 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8476 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8477 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8478 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8479 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8480 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8481 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8482 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8483 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8484 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8485 SIGTRAP.
8486
8487 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8488 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8489
8490 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8491 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8492 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8493 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8494 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8495 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8496 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8497 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8498 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8499 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8500 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8501 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8502 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8503 thread_count.
8504
8505 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8506 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8507 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8508 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8509
8510 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8511 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8512 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8513 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8514 traps we can no longer explain. */
8515
8516 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8517 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8518
8519 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8520 }
8521 else
8522 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8523 }
8524 }
8525
8526 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8527 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8528 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8529 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8530 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8531 are sorted first for the same address.
8532
8533 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8534 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8535
8536 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8537 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8538 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8539 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8540 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8541 {
8542 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8543 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8544
8545 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8546 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8547 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8548 || !loc->enabled
8549 || loc->shlib_disabled
8550 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b))
8551 continue;
8552
8553 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8554 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8555 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8556 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8557 "actually inserted"));
8558
8559 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8560 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8561 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8562 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8563 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8564 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8565 else
8566 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8567
8568 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8569 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8570 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8571 {
8572 *loc_first_p = loc;
8573 loc->duplicate = 0;
8574 continue;
8575 }
8576
8577 loc->duplicate = 1;
8578
8579 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8580 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8581 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8582 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8583 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8584 }
8585
8586 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8587 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8588 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8589 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8590
8591 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8592 }
8593
8594 void
8595 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8596 {
8597 struct bp_location *loc;
8598 int ix;
8599
8600 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8601 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8602 {
8603 free_bp_location (loc);
8604 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8605 --ix;
8606 }
8607 }
8608
8609 static void
8610 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8611 {
8612 struct gdb_exception e;
8613 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8614 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8615 }
8616
8617 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8618 static void
8619 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8620 {
8621 bpstat bs;
8622 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8623 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8624 {
8625 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8626 bs->old_val = NULL;
8627 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8628 }
8629 }
8630
8631 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8632 static int
8633 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8634 {
8635 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8636 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8637 return 0;
8638 }
8639
8640 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8641 structures. */
8642
8643 void
8644 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8645 {
8646 struct breakpoint *b;
8647 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8648
8649 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8650
8651 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8652 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8653
8654 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8655 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8656 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8657 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8658 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8659
8660 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8661 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8662 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8663 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8664 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8665 return;
8666
8667 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8668
8669 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8670 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8671
8672 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8673 if (b->next == bpt)
8674 {
8675 b->next = bpt->next;
8676 break;
8677 }
8678
8679 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8680 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8681 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8682 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8683 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8684 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8685 xfree (bpt->exp);
8686 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8687 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8688 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8689 value_free (bpt->val);
8690 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8691 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8692 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8693 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8694 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8695
8696 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8697 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8698 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8699 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8700 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8701 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8702 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8703 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8704 with commands won't work. */
8705
8706 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8707
8708 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8709 list, update the global location list. This
8710 will remove locations that used to belong to
8711 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8712 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8713 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8714 design to have location completely self-contained,
8715 but it's not the case now. */
8716 update_global_location_list (0);
8717
8718
8719 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8720 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8721 bpt->type = bp_none;
8722
8723 xfree (bpt);
8724 }
8725
8726 static void
8727 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8728 {
8729 delete_breakpoint (b);
8730 }
8731
8732 struct cleanup *
8733 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8734 {
8735 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8736 }
8737
8738 void
8739 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8740 {
8741 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8742
8743 dont_repeat ();
8744
8745 if (arg == 0)
8746 {
8747 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8748
8749 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8750 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8751 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8752 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8753 {
8754 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8755 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8756 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8757 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8758 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8759 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8760 && b->number >= 0)
8761 {
8762 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8763 break;
8764 }
8765 }
8766
8767 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8768 if (!from_tty
8769 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8770 {
8771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8772 {
8773 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8774 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8775 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8776 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8777 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8778 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8779 && b->number >= 0)
8780 delete_breakpoint (b);
8781 }
8782 }
8783 }
8784 else
8785 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8786 }
8787
8788 static int
8789 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8790 {
8791 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8792 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8793 return 0;
8794 return 1;
8795 }
8796
8797 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8798 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8799 Null names are ignored. */
8800
8801 static int
8802 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8803 {
8804 struct bp_location *l;
8805 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8806 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8807 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8808
8809 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8810 {
8811 const char **slot;
8812 const char *name = l->function_name;
8813
8814 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8815 if (name == NULL)
8816 continue;
8817
8818 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8819 INSERT);
8820 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8821 NULL. */
8822 if (*slot != NULL)
8823 {
8824 htab_delete (htab);
8825 return 1;
8826 }
8827 *slot = name;
8828 }
8829
8830 htab_delete (htab);
8831 return 0;
8832 }
8833
8834 static void
8835 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8836 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8837 {
8838 int i;
8839 char *s;
8840 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8841
8842 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8843 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
8844 the common case where all locations are in the same
8845 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8846 retain the location, so that when the library
8847 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8848 status of the individual locations. */
8849 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8850 return;
8851
8852 b->loc = NULL;
8853
8854 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8855 {
8856 struct bp_location *new_loc =
8857 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8858
8859 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8860 old symtab. */
8861 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8862 {
8863 struct gdb_exception e;
8864
8865 s = b->cond_string;
8866 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8867 {
8868 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8869 0);
8870 }
8871 if (e.reason < 0)
8872 {
8873 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8874 b->number, e.message);
8875 new_loc->enabled = 0;
8876 }
8877 }
8878
8879 if (b->source_file != NULL)
8880 xfree (b->source_file);
8881 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8882 b->source_file = NULL;
8883 else
8884 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8885
8886 if (b->line_number == 0)
8887 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8888 }
8889
8890 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
8891 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8892 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8893
8894 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
8895 {
8896 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8897 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8898 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8899 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8900 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8901 often enough until a better solution is found. */
8902 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8903
8904 for (; e; e = e->next)
8905 {
8906 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8907 {
8908 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8909 if (have_ambiguous_names)
8910 {
8911 for (; l; l = l->next)
8912 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8913 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8914 {
8915 l->enabled = 0;
8916 break;
8917 }
8918 }
8919 else
8920 {
8921 for (; l; l = l->next)
8922 if (l->function_name
8923 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8924 {
8925 l->enabled = 0;
8926 break;
8927 }
8928 }
8929 }
8930 }
8931 }
8932
8933 update_global_location_list (1);
8934 }
8935
8936
8937 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8938 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8939 Unused in this case. */
8940
8941 static int
8942 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8943 {
8944 /* get past catch_errs */
8945 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8946 struct value *mark;
8947 int i;
8948 int not_found = 0;
8949 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8950 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8951 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8952 char *s;
8953 enum enable_state save_enable;
8954 struct gdb_exception e;
8955 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8956
8957 switch (b->type)
8958 {
8959 case bp_none:
8960 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
8961 b->number);
8962 return 0;
8963 case bp_breakpoint:
8964 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
8965 case bp_tracepoint:
8966 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
8967 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
8968 return 0;
8969
8970 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
8971 {
8972 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
8973 delete_breakpoint (b);
8974 return 0;
8975 }
8976
8977 set_language (b->language);
8978 input_radix = b->input_radix;
8979 s = b->addr_string;
8980
8981 save_current_space_and_thread ();
8982 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
8983
8984 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8985 {
8986 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
8987 not_found_ptr);
8988 }
8989 if (e.reason < 0)
8990 {
8991 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
8992 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
8993 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
8994 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
8995 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
8996 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
8997 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
8998 if (not_found
8999 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9000 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9001 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9002 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9003
9004 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9005 {
9006 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9007 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9008 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9009 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9010 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9011 which approach is better. */
9012 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9013 throw_exception (e);
9014 }
9015 }
9016
9017 if (!not_found)
9018 {
9019 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9020
9021 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9022 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9023 {
9024 char *cond_string = 0;
9025 int thread = -1;
9026 int task = 0;
9027
9028 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9029 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9030 if (cond_string)
9031 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9032 b->thread = thread;
9033 b->task = task;
9034 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9035 }
9036
9037 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9038 }
9039
9040 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9041 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9042 break;
9043
9044 case bp_watchpoint:
9045 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9046 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9047 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9048 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9049 or it can be on local variables.
9050
9051 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9052 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9053 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9054 and unloaded.
9055
9056 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9057 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9058 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9059 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9060 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9061 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9062
9063 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9064 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9065 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9066 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9067
9068 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9069 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9070
9071 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9072 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9073 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9074 break;
9075 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9076 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9077 loaded. */
9078 case bp_catchpoint:
9079 break;
9080
9081 default:
9082 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9083 /* fall through */
9084 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9085 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9086 case bp_overlay_event:
9087 case bp_longjmp_master:
9088 delete_breakpoint (b);
9089 break;
9090
9091 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9092 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9093 case bp_shlib_event:
9094
9095 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9096 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9097 case bp_thread_event:
9098
9099 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9100 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9101 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9102 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9103 case bp_until:
9104 case bp_finish:
9105 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9106 case bp_call_dummy:
9107 case bp_step_resume:
9108 case bp_longjmp:
9109 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9110 case bp_jit_event:
9111 break;
9112 }
9113
9114 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9115 return 0;
9116 }
9117
9118 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9119 void
9120 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9121 {
9122 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9123 enum language save_language;
9124 int save_input_radix;
9125 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9126
9127 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9128 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9129 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9130
9131 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9132 {
9133 /* Format possible error msg */
9134 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9135 b->number);
9136 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9137 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9138 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9139 }
9140 set_language (save_language);
9141 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9142
9143 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9144
9145 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9146
9147 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9148 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9149 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9150 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9151 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9152 }
9153 \f
9154 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9155
9156 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9157 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9158 void
9159 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9160 {
9161 if (b->thread != -1)
9162 {
9163 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9164 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9165
9166 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9167 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9168 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9169 as well. */
9170 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9171 }
9172 }
9173
9174 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9175 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9176 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9177
9178 void
9179 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9180 {
9181 struct breakpoint *b;
9182
9183 if (count < 0)
9184 count = 0;
9185
9186 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9187 if (b->number == bptnum)
9188 {
9189 b->ignore_count = count;
9190 if (from_tty)
9191 {
9192 if (count == 0)
9193 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9194 bptnum);
9195 else if (count == 1)
9196 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9197 bptnum);
9198 else
9199 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9200 count, bptnum);
9201 }
9202 breakpoints_changed ();
9203 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9204 return;
9205 }
9206
9207 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9208 }
9209
9210 void
9211 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9212 {
9213 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9214 b->silent = 1;
9215 }
9216
9217 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9218
9219 static void
9220 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9221 {
9222 char *p = args;
9223 int num;
9224
9225 if (p == 0)
9226 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9227
9228 num = get_number (&p);
9229 if (num == 0)
9230 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9231 if (*p == 0)
9232 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9233
9234 set_ignore_count (num,
9235 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9236 from_tty);
9237 if (from_tty)
9238 printf_filtered ("\n");
9239 }
9240 \f
9241 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9242 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9243
9244 static void
9245 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9246 {
9247 char *p = args;
9248 char *p1;
9249 int num;
9250 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9251 int match;
9252
9253 if (p == 0)
9254 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9255
9256 while (*p)
9257 {
9258 match = 0;
9259 p1 = p;
9260
9261 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9262 if (num == 0)
9263 {
9264 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9265 }
9266 else
9267 {
9268 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9269 if (b->number == num)
9270 {
9271 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9272 match = 1;
9273 function (b);
9274 if (related_breakpoint)
9275 function (related_breakpoint);
9276 break;
9277 }
9278 if (match == 0)
9279 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9280 }
9281 p = p1;
9282 }
9283 }
9284
9285 static struct bp_location *
9286 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9287 {
9288 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9289 char *p1;
9290 int bp_num;
9291 int loc_num;
9292 struct breakpoint *b;
9293 struct bp_location *loc;
9294
9295 *dot = '\0';
9296
9297 p1 = number;
9298 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9299 if (bp_num == 0)
9300 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9301
9302 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9303 if (b->number == bp_num)
9304 {
9305 break;
9306 }
9307
9308 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9309 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9310
9311 p1 = dot+1;
9312 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9313 if (loc_num == 0)
9314 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9315
9316 --loc_num;
9317 loc = b->loc;
9318 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9319 ;
9320 if (!loc)
9321 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9322
9323 return loc;
9324 }
9325
9326
9327 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9328 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9329 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9330
9331 void
9332 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9333 {
9334 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9335 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9336 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9337 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9338 return;
9339
9340 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9341 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9342 return;
9343
9344 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9345
9346 update_global_location_list (0);
9347
9348 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9349 }
9350
9351 static void
9352 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9353 {
9354 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9355 if (args == 0)
9356 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9357 switch (bpt->type)
9358 {
9359 case bp_none:
9360 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9361 bpt->number);
9362 continue;
9363 case bp_breakpoint:
9364 case bp_tracepoint:
9365 case bp_catchpoint:
9366 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9367 case bp_watchpoint:
9368 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9369 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9370 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9371 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9372 default:
9373 continue;
9374 }
9375 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9376 {
9377 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9378 if (loc)
9379 loc->enabled = 0;
9380 update_global_location_list (0);
9381 }
9382 else
9383 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9384 }
9385
9386 static void
9387 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9388 {
9389 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9390 struct value *mark;
9391
9392 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9393 {
9394 int i;
9395 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9396 target_resources_ok =
9397 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9398 i + 1, 0);
9399 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9400 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9401 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9402 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9403 }
9404
9405 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9406 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9407 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9408 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9409 {
9410 struct gdb_exception e;
9411
9412 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9413 {
9414 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9415 }
9416 if (e.reason < 0)
9417 {
9418 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9419 bpt->number);
9420 return;
9421 }
9422 }
9423
9424 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9425 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9426 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9427 update_global_location_list (1);
9428 breakpoints_changed ();
9429
9430 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9431 }
9432
9433
9434 void
9435 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9436 {
9437 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9438 }
9439
9440 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9441 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9442 in stopping the inferior. */
9443
9444 static void
9445 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9446 {
9447 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9448 if (args == 0)
9449 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9450 switch (bpt->type)
9451 {
9452 case bp_none:
9453 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9454 bpt->number);
9455 continue;
9456 case bp_breakpoint:
9457 case bp_tracepoint:
9458 case bp_catchpoint:
9459 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9460 case bp_watchpoint:
9461 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9462 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9463 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9464 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9465 default:
9466 continue;
9467 }
9468 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9469 {
9470 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9471 if (loc)
9472 loc->enabled = 1;
9473 update_global_location_list (1);
9474 }
9475 else
9476 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9477 }
9478
9479 static void
9480 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9481 {
9482 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9483 }
9484
9485 static void
9486 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9487 {
9488 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9489 }
9490
9491 static void
9492 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9493 {
9494 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9495 }
9496
9497 static void
9498 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9499 {
9500 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9501 }
9502 \f
9503 static void
9504 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9505 {
9506 }
9507
9508 static void
9509 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9510 {
9511 }
9512
9513 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9514 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9515 GDB itself. */
9516
9517 static void
9518 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9519 const bfd_byte *data)
9520 {
9521 struct breakpoint *bp;
9522
9523 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9524 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9525 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9526 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9527 {
9528 struct bp_location *loc;
9529
9530 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9531 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9532 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9533 && addr + len > loc->address)
9534 {
9535 value_free (bp->val);
9536 bp->val = NULL;
9537 bp->val_valid = 0;
9538 }
9539 }
9540 }
9541
9542 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9543
9544 struct symtabs_and_lines
9545 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9546 {
9547 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9548 if (string == 0)
9549 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9550 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9551 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9552 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9553 default_breakpoint_line,
9554 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9555 else
9556 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9557 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9558 if (*string)
9559 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9560 return sals;
9561 }
9562
9563 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9564 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9565 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9566 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9567 someday. */
9568
9569 void *
9570 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9571 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9572 {
9573 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9574
9575 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9576
9577 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9578 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9579
9580 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9581 {
9582 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9583 xfree (bp_tgt);
9584 return NULL;
9585 }
9586
9587 return bp_tgt;
9588 }
9589
9590 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9591
9592 int
9593 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9594 {
9595 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9596 int ret;
9597
9598 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9599 xfree (bp_tgt);
9600
9601 return ret;
9602 }
9603
9604 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9605
9606 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9607 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9608
9609 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9610
9611 void
9612 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9613 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9614 {
9615 void **bpt_p;
9616
9617 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9618 {
9619 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9620 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9621 }
9622 else
9623 {
9624 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9625 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9626 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9627 }
9628
9629 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9630 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9631 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9632 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9633 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9634 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9635
9636 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9637 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9638 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9639 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9640 }
9641
9642 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9643
9644 void
9645 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9646 {
9647 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9648
9649 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9650 call. */
9651 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9652 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9653 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9654 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9655
9656 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9657 {
9658 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9659 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9660 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9661 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9662 }
9663 }
9664
9665 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9666
9667 static int
9668 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9669 {
9670 int i;
9671
9672 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9673 {
9674 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9675 if (bp_tgt
9676 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9677 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9678 aspace, pc))
9679 return 1;
9680 }
9681
9682 return 0;
9683 }
9684
9685 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9686 non-zero otherwise. */
9687 static int
9688 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9689 {
9690 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9691 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9692 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9693 return 1;
9694 else
9695 return 0;
9696 }
9697
9698 int
9699 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9700 {
9701 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9702
9703 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9704 }
9705
9706 int
9707 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9708 {
9709 struct breakpoint *bp;
9710
9711 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9712 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9713 {
9714 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9715 {
9716 int i, iter;
9717 for (i = 0;
9718 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9719 i++)
9720 if (syscall_number == iter)
9721 return 1;
9722 }
9723 else
9724 return 1;
9725 }
9726
9727 return 0;
9728 }
9729
9730 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9731 static char **
9732 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9733 char *text, char *word)
9734 {
9735 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9736 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9737 }
9738
9739 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9740
9741 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9742 static void
9743 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9744 {
9745 tracepoint_count = num;
9746 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9747 }
9748
9749 void
9750 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9751 {
9752 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9753 arg,
9754 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9755 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9756 1 /* traceflag */,
9757 0 /* Ignore count */,
9758 pending_break_support,
9759 NULL,
9760 from_tty,
9761 1 /* enabled */);
9762 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9763 }
9764
9765 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9766 omitted. */
9767
9768 static void
9769 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9770 {
9771 struct breakpoint *b;
9772 int tps_to_list = 0;
9773
9774 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
9775 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9776 {
9777 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9778 {
9779 if (b->number >= 0)
9780 {
9781 tps_to_list = 1;
9782 break;
9783 }
9784 }
9785 if (!tps_to_list)
9786 {
9787 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9788 return;
9789 }
9790 }
9791
9792 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
9793 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9794 }
9795
9796 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9797 Not supported by all targets. */
9798 static void
9799 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9800 {
9801 enable_command (args, from_tty);
9802 }
9803
9804 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9805 Not supported by all targets. */
9806 static void
9807 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9808 {
9809 disable_command (args, from_tty);
9810 }
9811
9812 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9813 static void
9814 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9815 {
9816 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9817
9818 dont_repeat ();
9819
9820 if (arg == 0)
9821 {
9822 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9823
9824 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9825 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9826 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9827 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9828 {
9829 if (b->number >= 0)
9830 {
9831 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9832 break;
9833 }
9834 }
9835
9836 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9837 if (!from_tty
9838 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9839 {
9840 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9841 {
9842 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint
9843 && b->number >= 0)
9844 delete_breakpoint (b);
9845 }
9846 }
9847 }
9848 else
9849 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9850 }
9851
9852 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9853
9854 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9855 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9856 Also accepts special argument "all". */
9857
9858 static void
9859 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9860 {
9861 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9862 unsigned int count;
9863 int all = 0;
9864
9865 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9866 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9867
9868 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9869
9870 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9871 args++;
9872
9873 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9874 {
9875 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
9876 all = 1;
9877 if (*args)
9878 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9879 }
9880 else
9881 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9882
9883 do
9884 {
9885 if (t1)
9886 {
9887 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
9888 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
9889 {
9890 t2->pass_count = count;
9891 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
9892 if (from_tty)
9893 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
9894 t2->number, count);
9895 }
9896 if (! all && *args)
9897 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
9898 }
9899 }
9900 while (*args);
9901 }
9902
9903 struct breakpoint *
9904 get_tracepoint (int num)
9905 {
9906 struct breakpoint *t;
9907
9908 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9909 if (t->number == num)
9910 return t;
9911
9912 return NULL;
9913 }
9914
9915 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
9916 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
9917 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
9918 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
9919 struct breakpoint *
9920 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
9921 {
9922 extern int tracepoint_count;
9923 struct breakpoint *t;
9924 int tpnum;
9925 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
9926
9927 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
9928 {
9929 if (optional_p)
9930 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
9931 else
9932 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
9933 }
9934 else
9935 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
9936
9937 if (tpnum <= 0)
9938 {
9939 if (instring && *instring)
9940 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
9941 instring);
9942 else
9943 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
9944 return NULL;
9945 }
9946
9947 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9948 if (t->number == tpnum)
9949 {
9950 return t;
9951 }
9952
9953 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
9954 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
9955 allow us to discover this. */
9956 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
9957 return NULL;
9958 }
9959
9960 /* save-tracepoints command */
9961 static void
9962 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9963 {
9964 struct breakpoint *tp;
9965 int any_tp = 0;
9966 struct action_line *line;
9967 FILE *fp;
9968 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
9969 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
9970 char tmp[40];
9971 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9972
9973 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9974 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
9975
9976 /* See if we have anything to save. */
9977 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9978 {
9979 any_tp = 1;
9980 break;
9981 }
9982 if (!any_tp)
9983 {
9984 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
9985 return;
9986 }
9987
9988 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
9989 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
9990 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
9991 if (!fp)
9992 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
9993 args, safe_strerror (errno));
9994 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
9995
9996 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9997 {
9998 if (tp->addr_string)
9999 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10000 else
10001 {
10002 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10003 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10004 }
10005
10006 if (tp->pass_count)
10007 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10008
10009 if (tp->actions)
10010 {
10011 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10012 indent = i1;
10013 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10014 {
10015 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10016
10017 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10018 actionline = line->action;
10019 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10020 actionline++;
10021
10022 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10023 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10024 {
10025 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10026 if (cmd == 0)
10027 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10028 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10029 indent = i2;
10030 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10031 indent = i1;
10032 }
10033 }
10034 }
10035 }
10036 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10037 if (from_tty)
10038 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10039 return;
10040 }
10041
10042 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10043
10044 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10045 all_tracepoints ()
10046 {
10047 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10048 struct breakpoint *tp;
10049
10050 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10051 {
10052 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10053 }
10054
10055 return tp_vec;
10056 }
10057
10058 \f
10059 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10060 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10061 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10062 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10063 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10064 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10065 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10066 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10067 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10068 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10069 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10070 \n\
10071 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10072 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10073 \n\
10074 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10075 \n\
10076 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10077
10078 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10079 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10080
10081 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10082 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10083
10084 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10085 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10086 static void
10087 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10088 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10089 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10090 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10091 char *text, char *word),
10092 void *user_data_catch,
10093 void *user_data_tcatch)
10094 {
10095 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10096
10097 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10098 &catch_cmdlist);
10099 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10100 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10101 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10102
10103 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10104 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10105 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10106 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10107 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10108 }
10109
10110 static void
10111 clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10112 {
10113 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10114
10115 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10116 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10117 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10118 }
10119
10120 void
10121 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10122 {
10123 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10124 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10125 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10126
10127 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10128 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10129 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10130
10131 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10132 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10133 before a breakpoint is set. */
10134 breakpoint_count = 0;
10135
10136 tracepoint_count = 0;
10137
10138 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10139 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10140 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10141 if (xdb_commands)
10142 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10143
10144 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10145 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10146 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10147 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10148 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10149 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10150 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10151 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10152
10153 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10154 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10155 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10156 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10157
10158 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10159 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10160 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10161 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10162 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10163 \n"
10164 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10165 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10166
10167 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10168 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10169 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10170 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10171 \n"
10172 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10173 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10174
10175 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10176 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10177 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10178 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10179 \n"
10180 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10181 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10182
10183 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10184 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10185 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10186 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10187 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10188 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10189 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10190 if (xdb_commands)
10191 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10192 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10193 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10194 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10195 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10196 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10197
10198 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10199
10200 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10201 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10202 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10203 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10204 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10205 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10206
10207 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10208 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10209 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10210 &enablebreaklist);
10211
10212 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10213 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10214 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10215 &enablebreaklist);
10216
10217 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10218 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10219 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10220 &enablelist);
10221
10222 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10223 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10224 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10225 &enablelist);
10226
10227 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10228 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10229 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10230 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10231 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10232 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10233 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10234 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10235 if (xdb_commands)
10236 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10237 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10238 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10239 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10240 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10241
10242 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10243 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10244 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10245 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10246 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10247 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10248 &disablelist);
10249
10250 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10251 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10252 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10253 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10254 \n\
10255 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10256 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10257 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10258 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10259 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10260 if (xdb_commands)
10261 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10262 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10263 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10264 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10265
10266 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10267 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10268 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10269 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10270 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10271 &deletelist);
10272
10273 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10274 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10275 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10276 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10277 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10278 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10279 \n\
10280 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10281 is executing in.\n\
10282 \n\
10283 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10284
10285 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10286 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10287 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10288 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10289
10290 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10291 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10292 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10293 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10294
10295 if (xdb_commands)
10296 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10297
10298 if (dbx_commands)
10299 {
10300 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10301 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10302 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10303 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10304 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10305 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10306 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10307 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10308 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10309 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10310 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10311 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10312 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10313 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10314 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10315 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10316 \n\
10317 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10318 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10319 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10320 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10321 breakpoint set."));
10322 }
10323
10324 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10325 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10326 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10327 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10328 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10329 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10330 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10331 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10332 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10333 \n\
10334 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10335 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10336 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10337 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10338 breakpoint set."));
10339
10340 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10341
10342 if (xdb_commands)
10343 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10344 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10345 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10346 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10347 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10348 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10349 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10350 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10351 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10352 \n\
10353 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10354 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10355 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10356 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10357 breakpoint set."));
10358
10359 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10360 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10361 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10362 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10363 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10364 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10365 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10366 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10367 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10368 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10369 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10370 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10371 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10372 \n\
10373 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10374 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10375 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10376 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10377 breakpoint set."),
10378 &maintenanceinfolist);
10379
10380 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10381 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10382 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10383 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10384
10385 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10386 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10387 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10388 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10389
10390 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10391 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10392 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10393 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10394 catch_catch_command,
10395 NULL,
10396 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10397 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10398 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10399 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10400 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10401 catch_throw_command,
10402 NULL,
10403 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10404 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10405 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10406 catch_fork_command_1,
10407 NULL,
10408 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10409 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10410 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10411 catch_fork_command_1,
10412 NULL,
10413 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10414 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10415 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10416 catch_exec_command_1,
10417 NULL,
10418 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10419 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10420 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10421 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10422 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10423 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10424 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10425 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10426 catch_syscall_command_1,
10427 catch_syscall_completer,
10428 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10429 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10430 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10431 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10432 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10433 catch_ada_exception_command,
10434 NULL,
10435 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10436 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10437 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10438 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10439 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10440 catch_assert_command,
10441 NULL,
10442 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10443 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10444
10445 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10446 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10447 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10448 an expression changes."));
10449 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10450
10451 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10452 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10453 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10454 an expression is read."));
10455 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10456
10457 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10458 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10459 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10460 an expression is either read or written."));
10461 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10462
10463 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10464 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10465
10466
10467 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10468 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10469 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10470 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10471 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10472 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10473 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10474 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10475 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10476 hardware.)"),
10477 NULL,
10478 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10479 &setlist, &showlist);
10480
10481 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10482
10483 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10484
10485 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10486 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10487 \n"
10488 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10489 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10490 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10491
10492 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10493 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10494 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10495 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10496
10497 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10498 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10499 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10500 last tracepoint set."));
10501
10502 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10503
10504 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10505 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10506 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10507 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10508 &deletelist);
10509
10510 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10511 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10512 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10513 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10514 &disablelist);
10515 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10516
10517 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10518 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10519 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10520 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10521 &enablelist);
10522 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10523
10524 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10525 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10526 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10527 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10528 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10529
10530 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10531 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10532 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10533 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10534
10535 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10536 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10537 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10538 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10539 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10540 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10541 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10542 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10543 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10544 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10545 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10546 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10547
10548 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10549 &pending_break_support, _("\
10550 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10551 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10552 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10553 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10554 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10555 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10556 NULL,
10557 show_pending_break_support,
10558 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10559 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10560
10561 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10562
10563 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10564 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10565 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10566 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10567 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10568 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10569 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10570 NULL,
10571 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10572 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10573 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10574
10575 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10576 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10577 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10578 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10579 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10580 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10581 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10582 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10583 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10584 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10585 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10586 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10587 NULL,
10588 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10589 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10590 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10591
10592 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10593
10594 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10595 }